XV-DV900
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Wall-mounting the center and
surround speaker system
VOLTAGE SELECTOR SWITCH
Only multi-voltage model is provided with
this switch.
Always check that selector are set properly
before plugging the power cord into the wall
outlet.
1. Disconnect the power cord.
2. Use a small-sized screwdriver.
3. Insert the screwdriver into the groove on
the voltage selector, and adjust the
VOLTAGE SELECTOR.
Before mounting
• Remember that the speaker system is heavy
and that its weight could cause the wood
screws to work loose, or the wall material to
fail to support it, resulting in the speaker
falling. Make sure that the wall you intend to
mount the speakers on is strong enough to
support them. Do not mount on plywood or
soft surface walls.
• Mounting screws are not supplied. Use
screws that are suitable for the wall material
and that will support the weight of the
speaker.
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
240 V
5 mm
220V
–230V
10 mm
5 mm
Wood screw
110V
–120V
Protrusion: 5-7mm
CAUTION 240 V
Power source voltage is factory adjusted at
240 volts. If your area is different, change
the voltage selector’s setting.
H039En
• If you are unsure of the qualities and
strength of the walls, consult a professional
for advice.
• Pioneer is not responsible for any accidents
or damage that result from improper
installation.
On the inside cover of the unit.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
These labels can be found on the
DVD/CD tuner rear panel and bottom
panel and on the powered subwoofer
rear panel.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
[For Taiwanese model]
Please read through these operating
instructions so you will know how to
operate your model properly. After you have
finished reading the instructions, put them
away in a safe place for future reference.
This player is not suitable for commercial
use.
Installation precaution
• Install components so that there are no
obstructions above or either side, and
nothing blocking ventilation holes.
• Leave at least 5 cm of free space around
the subwoofer and at least 28cm above and
15cm to the left and right of the DVD/CD
Tuner, as shown below. Remember to also
leave 15cm of space at the rear.
This product incorporates copyright
protection technology that is protected by
method claims of certain U.S. patents and
other intellectual property rights owned by
Macrovision Corporation and other rights
owners. Use of this copyright protection
technology must be authorized by
Macrovision Corporation, and is intended
for home and other limited viewing uses
only unless otherwise authorized by
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse
• Use a vacuum cleaner periodically to clean
the port of the subwoofer to keep it free of
dust.
5 cm
engineering or disassembly is prohibited.
This product is for general household
purposes. Any failure due to use for other
than household purposes (such as long-
term use for business purposes in a
restaurant or use in a car or ship) and
which requires repair will be charged for
even during the warranty period. K041_En
Energy-saving design
This system is designed to use 0.55 W of
electricity when power is switched to
standby.
Powered subwoofer unit (S-DV900/700SW)
28 cm
DVD/CD Tuner unit (XV-DV900/700)
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Thank you for buying this Pioneer product.
Please read through these operating instructions so that you will know how to operate your
model properly. After you have finished reading the instructions, put them in a safe place for
future reference.
Contents
01 Before you start
04 Home theater sound
Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Introduction to home theater . . . . . . . . . . . 9
General disc compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
CD-R/RW compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
DVD-R/RW compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
PC-created disc compatibility . . . . . . . . 10
Compressed audio compatibility . . . . . . 10
JPEG file compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Auto listening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Listening in surround sound . . . . . . . . . . .30
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings . . . . . .31
Listening in stereo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Listening with headphones . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Using the Advanced Surround effects . . . .32
Adjusting the Advanced Surround effect
level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Enhancing dialogue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Listening with a virtual surround back
speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Using Quiet and Midnight listening
modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Adjusting the bass and treble . . . . . . . . . .35
Boosting the bass level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Muting the sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
02 Controls and displays
Front panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
03 Getting started
Switching on and setting up. . . . . . . . . . . 18
Setting the clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Setting up the remote to control your
05 Playing discs
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Using the Disc Navigator to browse the
TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Using the Room Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Using the on-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . 21
Playing discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Basic playback controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Resume and Last Memory . . . . . . . . . . . 24
DVD disc menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus . . . . . 26
Listening to the radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Improving poor FM reception. . . . . . . . . 28
Memorizing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . 29
Listening to other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
contents of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Scanning discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . . .39
Looping a section of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Using repeat play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Using the display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Using random play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Creating a program list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Using the OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Using the unit display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Clearing the program list . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Searching a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Playing DVD-Audio ‘Bonus Groups’. . . . . .47
Switching subtitles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Switching DVD-Video audio language . . . .47
5
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Switching DVD-Audio audio channels . . . 48
Switching Video CD/Super VCD audio
Display settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
OSD Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
On Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Angle Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Parental Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Bonus Group. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Auto Disc Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Group Playback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
DVD Playback Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
SACD Playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
PhotoViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Switching camera angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Displaying disc information . . . . . . . . . . . 49
OSD disc information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Display unit information . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
06 Viewing JPEG discs
Playing a JPEG slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Using the JPEG Disc Navigator and Photo
Browser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
11 Other connections
Connecting external antennas. . . . . . . . . .72
Connecting auxiliary components . . . . . . .72
Reducing the TV and line signal levels . .73
Recording mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Connecting using the S-video output. . . . .74
Connecting using the component video
output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
07 Using the timer
Setting the wake-up timer . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Turning the wake-up timer on/off . . . . . . 55
Setting the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
08 Surround sound setup
Setting up surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . 57
System Setup menu options . . . . . . . . . 57
Setting the channel levels . . . . . . . . . . . 59
12 Additional information
Switching off the demo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Child Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Changing the clock format . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Changing the frequency step. . . . . . . . . . .76
Setting the TV format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Watching NTSC on a PAL TV
09 Video Adjust menu
Video Adjust. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Creating your own presets . . . . . . . . . . . 60
(MOD. PAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Dimming the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Using and taking care of discs . . . . . . . . .78
Titles, groups, chapters and tracks . . . . .78
DVD Video regions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Handling discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Storing discs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Discs to avoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Proper installation and maintenance of this
system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Cleaning the pickup lens. . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Problems with condensation. . . . . . . . . .80
Moving the system unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Power cord caution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
10 Initial Settings menu
Using the Initial Settings menu . . . . . . . . 62
Digital Audio Mode Settings. . . . . . . . . . . 62
Dolby Digital Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
DTS Out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Linear PCM Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Video Output settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
TV Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Component Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
S-Video Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Language settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Audio Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Subtitle Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
DVD Menu Language. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Subtitle Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
6
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
DVD/CD/Video CD player. . . . . . . . . . . . 83
MP3/JPEG discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . . . 87
Widescreen TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Standard TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Selecting languages using the language code
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Language code list. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Country code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Preset code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
7
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
Before you start
CBhaepfteor 1re you start
Picture zoom
Features
While a DVD or Video CD/Super VCD is
playing, you can zoom in on any part of the
picture at up to 4x magnification for a closer
look. See Zooming the screen on page 48.
DVD-Audio and SACD compatible
Experience the super high-quality audio
performance of DVD-Audio and Super Audio
CD (SACD).
MP3 compatibility
The on-board 24-bit/192kHz DAC means that
this player is fully compatible with high
sampling-rate discs, capable of delivering
exceptional sound quality in terms of dynamic
range, low-level resolution and high-
frequency detail.
This system is compatible with CD-R, CD-RW
and CD-ROM discs that contain MP3 audio
tracks. See also Compressed audio
compatibility on page 10.
Graphical on-screen displays
Setting up and using your DVD home theater
system is made very easy using the graphical
on-screen displays.
Excellent audio performance with
Dolby Digital, Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby
*1
*2
Pro Logic II and DTS software
Energy saving design
This system is designed to use 0.55 W of
power when in standby mode.
Built-in Dolby Digital and DTS decoders let
you enjoy true discrete multi-channel home
theater sound with Dolby Digital and DTS
encoded DVD discs.
*1 Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
Dolby Pro Logic and Dolby Pro Logic II
decoding adds excitement to two-channel
source material with surround sound
playback.
*2 “DTS” and “DTS Digital Surround” are
registered trademarks of Digital Theater
Systems, Inc.
Simple Room Setup for surround sound
Setting up basic surround sound is made a
simple two step process with the Room Setup
feature. Tell the unit the size of your listening
room and your listening position, and the
system automatically configures the
surround sound.
8
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
Introduction to home theater General disc compatibility
You are probably used to using stereo
equipment to listen to music, but may not be
used to home theater systems that give you
many more options (such as surround sound)
when listening to soundtracks.
This system was designed and engineered to
be compatible with software bearing one or
more of the following logos:
Home theater refers to the use of multiple
audio tracks to create a surround sound
effect, making you feel like you're in the
middle of the action or concert. The surround
sound you get from a home theater system
depends not only on the speakers you have
set up in your room, but also on the source
and the sound settings of the system.
DVD-Audio DVD-Video
DVD-R
CD-R
DVD-RW
CD-RW
Audio CD
Video CD
DVD-Video has become the basic source
material for home theater due to its size,
quality, and ease of use. Depending on the
DVD, you can have up to six different audio
tracks coming from one disc, all of them
being sent to different speakers in your
system. This is what creates a surround
sound effect and gives you the feeling of
‘being there’.
Super Audio CD
Fujicolor CD
• KODAK Picture CD
is a trademark of Fuji Photo Film Co.
This system will automatically decode Dolby
Digital, DTS, or Dolby Surround DVD-Video
discs, according to your speaker setup. In
most cases, you won’t have to make changes
for realistic surround sound, but other
possibilities (like listening to a CD with multi-
channel surround sound) are explained in
Home theater sound on page 30.
•
Ltd.
This player supports the IEC’s Super VCD
standard. Compared to the Video CD
standard, Super VCD offers superior picture
quality, and allows two stereo soundtracks to
be recorded. Super VCD also supports the
widescreen size.
VIDEO
CD
Super Video CD (Super VCD)
Other formats, including but not limited to the
following, are not playable in this system:
DVD-RAM / DVD-ROM / CD-ROM*
* Except those that contain MP3 or JPEG.
See also Compressed audio compatibility
and JPEG file compatibility below.
9
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
Before you start
DVD-R/RW and CD-R/RW discs (Audio CDs
and Video CDs) recorded using a DVD
recorder, CD recorder or personal computer
may not be playable on this system. This may
be caused by a number of possibilities,
including but not limited to: the type of disc
used; the type of recording; damage, dirt or
condensation on either the disc or the
player’s pick-up lens. See below for notes
about particular software and formats.
PC-created disc compatibility
• If you record a disc using a personal
computer, even if it is recorded in a
“compatible format” as listed above, there
will be cases in which the disc may not be
playable in this machine due to the
setting of the application software used to
create the disc. In these particular
instances, check with the software
publisher for more detailed information.
• Check the DVD-R/RW or CD-R/RW
software disc boxes for additional
compatibility information.
CD-R/RW compatibility
• This system will play CD-R and CD-RW
discs recorded in CD Audio or Video CD
format, or as a CD-ROM containing MP3
or JPEG files. However, any other content
may cause the disc not to play, or create
noise/distortion in the output.
Compressed audio compatibility
• This unit will play CD-ROM, CD-R, and
CD-RW discs containing files saved in the
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3) format with
a sampling rate of 32, 44.1 or 48kHz.
Incompatible files will not play and the
message Can’t play this format will be
displayed (No Play in the Display unit).
• This system cannot record CD-R or CD-
RW discs.
• Unfinalized CD-R/RW discs recorded as
CD Audio can be played, but the full Table
of Contents (playing time, etc.) will not be
displayed.
• Fixed bit-rate MP3 files are
recommended. Variable bit-rate (VBR)
MP3 files are playable, but playing time
may not be shown correctly.
DVD-R/RW compatibility
• The CD-ROM used to compile your MP3
files must be ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2
compliant. CD physical format: Mode1,
Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file
systems are both compatible with this
player.
• This unit will play DVD-R/RW discs
recorded using the DVD-Video format that
have been finalized using a DVD-recorder.
• This unit will play DVD-RW discs recorded
using the Video Recording (VR) format.
• DVD-RW shows in the display when a VR
format DVD-RW disc is loading.
• Use CD-R or CD-RW media for recording
your files. The disc must be finalized (i.e.
the session must be closed) in order to
play in this unit. This player is not
compatible with multi-session discs. Only
the first session of a multi-session disc
will be recognized.
• When playing a VR format DVD-RW discs
that was edited on a DVD recorder, the
screen may go momentarily black at
edited points and/or you may see scenes
from immediately before the edited point.
• This unit cannot record DVD-R/RW discs.
• This player only plays tracks that are
named with the file extension .mp3 or
.MP3.
• Unfinalized DVD-R/RW discs cannot be
played in this player.
10
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Before you start
01
• When naming MP3 files, add the
corresponding file name extension
(.mp3). Files are played according to the
file extension. To prevent noise and
malfunctions, do not use these
extensions for other kinds of files.
• This player can recognize up to 999 files
(MP3/JPEG) and up to 499 folders. If a
disc exceeds these limits, only files and
folders up to these limits will be playable.
Files and folders are read/ displayed in
alphabetical order. Note that if the file
structure is very complex, you may not be
able to read/play all files on the disc.
• Folder and track names (excluding the file
extension) are displayed.
• There are many different recording bit-
rates available to encode MP3 files. This
unit was designed to be compatible with
all of them. Audio encoded at 128Kbps
should sound close to regular CD Audio
quality. This player will play lower bit-rate
files, but please note that the sound
quality becomes noticeably worse at
lower bit-rates.
JPEG file compatibility
• Baseline JPEG and EXIF 2.1* still image
files up to 8 mega-pixels are supported
(maximum vertical and horizontal
resolution is 5120 pixels). (*File format
used by digital still cameras)
• The CD-ROM used to compile your JPEG
files must be ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2
compliant. CD physical format: Mode1,
Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file
systems are both compatible with this
player.
• This player only displays files that are
named with the file extension .jpg or
.JPG.
11
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
Controls and displays
CChaoptnert2rols and displays
Front panel
1
2
3
TIMER
STANDBY/ON
OPEN/CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢂ
4
6
7
5
8
1
VOLUME buttons
5
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
Use to adjust the volume.
Press to switch the system on or into standby.
2
ꢀ
6
7
Disc tray
Press to stop playback.
ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
3
ꢁ
Press to open/close the disc tray.
Press to switch to the DVD/CD function. Also
press to start/pause/resume playback.
8
PHONES jack
Headphone jack.
4
Timer indicator
Lights when the wake-up timer is set (page 54).
Display unit
9
10
9
Remote sensor
10 Display
See Display on page 13 for detailed
information.
12
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
Display
3
5
1
2
4
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
14
MIDNIGHT QUIET
PGM RPT-1
RDM
V.PART
ATT
REC MODE
PRO LOGIC
DIGITAL
ADV.SURR.
PRGSVE
kHz
MHz
20
19
18 17 16 15
1
Tuner indicators
8
V.PART
Light when playing a video part of a DVD disc.
9
ATT
Lights when a broadcast is being
received.
Lights when the input attenuator is active for
the currently selected analog input (page 73).
10 REC MODE
Lights when Rec Mode is active (page 74).
Lights when a stereo FM broadcast is
being received in auto stereo mode.
11 Timer indicators
Lights when FM mono reception is
selected.
Lights when the wake-up timer is set
(page 54).
2
ꢄ
Lights when a disc is playing.
Lights when the sleep timer is active
(page 56).
3
MIDNIGHT
Lights when the Midnight mode is selected
(page 34).
12 2 PRO LOGIC II
Lights during Dolby Pro Logic decoding
(page 30).
4
QUIET
Lights when the Quiet mode is selected
(page 34).
13 2DIGITAL
Lights during playback of a Dolby Digital
source (page 30).
5
PGM
Lights when a program list has been
programmed (page 43).
6
RPT and RPT-1
RPT lights during repeat play. RPT-1 lights
during repeat one-track play (page 40).
7
RDM
Lights during random play (page 42).
13
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
Controls and displays
14 Speaker indicators
These show which speakers are being used to
output the current source. The illustrations
below show some example displays.
5.1 channel surround sound
Stereo (2.1 channel) sound
3.1 channel sound with Dialogue
enhancement on the center
channel
5.1 channel surround sound with
Virtual Surround Back mode active
15 PRGSVE
Lights when progressive scan video output is
selected (page 64).
16 ADV.SURR.
Lights when one of the Advanced Surround
listening modes is selected (page 32).
17 DTS
Lights during playback of a DTS source
(page 30).
18 kHz / MHz
Indicates the unit of the frequency shown in
the character display (kHz for AM, MHz for
FM).
19 Character display
20
Lights during multi-angle scenes on a DVD
disc (page 49).
14
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
3
DISPLAY
Remote control
Press to display/change disc information
shown on-screen (page 49).
STANDBY/ON
1
4
Disc playback controls
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
2
ꢄ
DISPLAY
OPEN/CLOSE
ꢃ
Press to start or resume playback.
3
4
5
6
7
ꢋ
11
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢅ and ꢆ/ꢇ
Use for reverse slow motion playback,
frame reverse and reverse scanning.
ꢌ
ꢌ
12
13
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ꢈ and ꢉ/ꢊ
Use for forward slow motion playback,
frame advance and forward scanning.
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
8
9
14
ꢋ
MASTER
VOLUME
Press to pause playback; press again to
restart.
TV CONTROL
10
15
CH
INPUT
VOL
ꢀ
Press to stop playback.
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
5
ꢌ
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
Press to jump to the beginning of the current
chapter/track, then to previous chapters/
tracks.
16
17
18
19
20
21
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
SETUP
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
6
DVD MENU
4
22
QUIET/
TIMER/
CLOCK
Press to display a DVD disc menu, or the Disc
Navigator if a VR format DVD-RW, CD, Video
CD/Super VCD, MP3 or JPEG disc is loaded.
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
7
Cursor buttons, ENTER and tuning
buttons
Cursor buttons
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to
navigate on-screen displays and menus.
• Functions printed in green on the remote
control are accessed by switching the
MAIN/SUB switch to SUB.
ENTER
Press to select an option or execute a
command.
1
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
Press to switch the system on or into standby.
TUNE +/–
Use to tune the radio.
2
Function select buttons
Press to select the source you want to listen to
(DVD (CD). TUNER, TV, LINE)
ST +/–
Use to select station presets when
listening to the radio.
15
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
Controls and displays
8
9
MUTE
(In SUB)
Press to mute all sound from the speakers
and headphones (press again to cancel)
(page 36).
BASS MODE
Use to select a Bass Mode (page 35).
DIALOGUE
Use to select a Dialogue mode (page 33).
MASTER VOLUME
Use to adjust the volume.
VIRTUAL SB
Press to switch the Virtual Surround Back
speaker effect on/off (page 34).
10 TV CONTROL (page 20)
ꢂ
Press to switch the TV on or into standby.
16 DVD/CD buttons
(In MAIN)
INPUT
Press to switch the TV input.
AUDIO
CH +/–
Press to select an audio channel or
language (page 47).
Use to select channels on the TV.
VOL +/–
SUBTITLE
Use to adjust the volume on the TV.
Press to display/change the DVD subtitle
display (page 47).
11 ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
Press to open/close the disc tray.
ANGLE
Press to change camera angle during
DVD multi-angle scene playback
(page 49).
12 ꢍ
Press to jump to the next chapter/track.
13 RETURN
Press to return to a previous menu screen.
(In SUB)
PROGRAM
Use to program/play a program list
(page 43).
14 SOUND
Press to access the sound menu, from which
you can adjust the DSP effect level, bass and
treble, etc.
REPEAT
Use to select a repeat play mode
(page 40).
15 Surround sound mode/sound
enhancement buttons
RANDOM
Use to select a random play mode
(page 42).
(In MAIN)
AUTO
Press to select the default decoding for
the current source (page 30).
17 (In SUB)
ZOOM
SURROUND
Use to select a Surround mode (page 30).
Press to change the screen zoom level
(page 48).
ADVANCED
Use to select an Advanced Surround
(page 32).
TOP MENU
Use to display the top menu of a DVD disc
in the play position (this may be the same
as pressing DVD MENU).
16
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Controls and displays
02
HOME MENU
21 MAIN / SUB
Press to display (or exit) the on-screen
menu for Initial Settings, Play Mode
functions, etc.
Change from MAIN to SUB to access
functions printed in green.
(In MAIN)
18 (In SUB)
ROOM SETUP
SYSTEM SETUP
Press to start Room Setup (page 20).
Use to make various system and surround
sound settings (page 57).
22 (In MAIN)
Number buttons
Use the number buttons for selecting
titles/chapters/tracks from a disc directly.
TEST TONE
Use to output the test tone (for speaker
setup) (page 59).
CH LEVEL
Use to adjust the speaker level (page 59).
19 (In SUB)
DIMMER
Press to dim or brighten the display.
QUIET/MIDNIGHT
Use to select the Quiet and Midnight
modes (page 34).
TIMER/CLOCK
Press to display the clock and to access
the timer menu (page 19 and page 54).
20 (In MAIN)
CLR
Press to clear an entry.
ENTER
Selects menu options, etc. (works exactly
the same as the ENTER button in 7
above).
(In SUB)
FOLDER –
Press to jump to previous folders.
FOLDER +
Press to jump to the next folder.
17
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
Chapter 3
Getting started
You should see the welcome screen
displayed.
Switching on and setting up
After making sure everything is connected up
properly, you’re ready to switch on. The first
thing to do is to tell the system what kind of TV
you’re using, standard or widescreen.
Welcome to Pioneer DVD!
Thank you for purchasing this Pioneer DVD player.
After that you can set up the surround sound
for your room, and set the clock so that you
can use the timer features.
Before using, please take a little time
to setup your DVD player
Put the batteries into the remote control
Next, press the [ENTER] button on the remote control
and start the Let's Get Started Menu
Next
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
2
Press ENTER to move on to the next
ꢃ
ꢋ
screen.
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
3
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
ꢌ
ꢌ
buttons to select either ‘Wide screen
(16:9)’ or ‘Standard size screen (4:3)’
according to the kind of TV you have, then
press ENTER.
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
See also Screen sizes and disc formats on
page 87 if you’re not sure which one to
choose.
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
Let's Get Started Menu
CH
INPUT
VOL
What kind of TV do you have?
Use the
/
cursor buttons
1
Press ꢂ STANDBY/ON (on the remote
to choose, then press [ENTER]
or on the front panel) to switch the
system on.
Also make sure that your TV is switched on
and that the video input is set to this system.
Wide screen (16:9)
Standard size screen (4:3)
18
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
4
Press ENTER again to finish setting up.
Setting the clock
Setting the clock allows you to use the timer
features.
Let's Get Started Menu
Setup complete
STANDBY/ON
If you're finished setting up,
choose [Complete],
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
to start again choose [Back]
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
Complete
Back
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
• Use the ꢃ (cursor right) button to select
Back then press ENTER if you want to go
back and change the setting you just
made.
ENTER
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
• You can also use the function buttons
(DVD/CD, TUNER, etc.) or the ꢃ OPEN/
CLOSE button to switch the system on
from standby.
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
1
2
Press TIMER/CLOCK.
• If you are adjusting the clock, rather then
setting it for the first time, press TIMER/
CLOCK again.
If ‘Clock ADJ?’ isn’t already showing in
the display, press ꢂ or ꢃ (cursor left or
right) until you see it.
3
4
Press ENTER.
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to set the hour.
5
Press ENTER.
19
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
6
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
MASTER
VOLUME
buttons to set the minute.
TV CONTROL
7
Press ENTER to confirm.
CH
INPUT
VOL
The display flashes to indicate the clock is set.
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
AUTO
VIRTUAL SB
SURROUND ADVANCED
• Press TIMER/CLOCK anytime to display
the clock.
Button
What it does
Switches your TV on or into
standby.
ꢂ
CH +/–
VOL +/–
INPUT
Changes the TV channel.
Adjusts the TV volume.
• If you unplug the system from the wall
outlet, or there is a power outage, you will
need to set the clock again.
Switches the TV’s input
between the built in TV tuner
and an external video source.
Setting up the remote to control
your TV
You can set up the supplied remote to control
your TV using the TV CONTROL buttons.
• The default setting is for a Pioneer TV.
1
Switch on your TV.
2
Find the name of the manufacturer of
Using the Room Setup
your TV in the Preset code list on page 89
Next to each manufacturer is one or more
three digit codes. These tell the remote what
kind of TV you have.
Before using your system to enjoy surround
sound playback, we recommend you spend a
few minutes using the Room Setup. This is a
quick and easy way to get good surround
sound for your room.
If the name of the manufacturer of your TV
does not appear in the table, you won’t be
able to set up this remote to control your TV.
Depending on the distance of the surround
speakers from your main listening position,
choose between S (small), M (medium), or L
(large) room, then depending on your seating
position relative to the front and surround
speakers, choose Fwd (forward), Mid
(middle), or Back.
3
Point the remote at your TV, hold
down the CLR button, then enter the
three digit code for your TV.
The remote transmits an on/off signal to the
TV. If you’ve entered the correct code, your TV
should switch off.
If your TV doesn’t turn off, repeat the
procedure using the next code in the list until
your TV switches off successfully. Once set,
you can then use the individual TV controls
shown below.
20
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
1
If the system isn’t already on, press
• For a more detailed surround sound
setup, see Setting up surround sound on
page 57.
ꢂ STANDBY/ON to switch it on.
2
Press ROOM SETUP.
• If you have previously set up the room type
and seating position, the display will show
the current room settings.
Using the on-screen displays
For ease of use, this system makes extensive
use of graphical on-screen displays (OSDs).
You should get used to the way these work as
you’ll need to use them when setting up the
system, using some of the playback features,
such as program play, and when making
more advanced settings for audio and video.
3
4
Press ENTER.
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select a room type then press
ENTER.
Choose one of the following depending on
your room size:
All the screens are navigated in basically the
same way, using the cursor buttons (ꢀ, ꢁ,
ꢂ, ꢃ) to change the highlighted item and
pressing ENTER to select it.
• S – Smaller than average room
• M – Average room
• L – Larger than average room
5
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select a seating position
setting, then press ENTER.
Choose one of the following depending on
where your main listening position is:
• Throughout this manual, ‘Select’ means
use the cursor buttons to highlight an
item on-screen, then press ENTER.
• Fwd – If you are nearer to the front
speakers than the surround speakers
• Mid – If you are equal distance from the
front and surround speakers
• Back – If you are nearer to the surround
speakers than the front speakers
• The Room Setup automatically sets up
both channel level and speaker distance.
If you have already set the channel levels
manually (see page 59) or speaker
distance settings (see page 58), you will
see Room Set? in the display when you
first press the ROOM SETUP button.
• Using the Room Setup will overwrite any
previous settings you had for channel
level and speaker distance.
21
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢋ
ꢈ
• The button guide at the bottom of every
OSD screen shows you which buttons
you’ll need to use for that screen.
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
ENTER
Playing discs
MUTE
SOUND
The basic playback controls for playing DVD,
CD, SACD, Video CD/Super VCD and MP3
discs are covered here. Further functions are
detailed in the chapter 5.
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
Throughout this manual, the term ‘DVD’
means any kind of DVD disc (DVD-Video,
DVD-Audio or DVD-R/RW).
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
1
If the player isn’t already on, press
ꢂ STANDBY/ON to switch it on.
If you’re playing a DVD or Video CD/Super
VCD also turn on your TV and make sure that
it is set to the correct video input.
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
2
Press ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE to open the disc
tray.
Button
What it does
3
Load a disc.
Displays/exits the on-screen
display
HOME
MENU
Load a disc with the label side facing up,
using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if
you’re loading a double-sided DVD disc, load
it with the side you want to play face down).
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ
Changes the highlighted menu
item
Selects the highlighted menu
item (both ENTER buttons work
in exactly the same way)
ENTER
Returns to the main menu
without saving changes
RETURN
22
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
4
Press ꢄ (play) to start playback.
Basic playback controls
If you’re playing a DVD or Video CD/Super
VCD, a menu may appear. See DVD disc
menus on page 25 and Video CD/Super VCD
PBC menus on page 26 for how to navigate
these.
The table below shows the basic controls on
the remote for playing discs. You can find
other playback features in the chapter 5.
STANDBY/ON
If you’re playing an MP3 disc, it may take a
few seconds before playback starts,
depending on the complexity of the file
structure on the disc.
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
If you loaded a CD/CD-R/RW containing
JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Viewing
JPEG discs on page 52 for more on playing
these discs.
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
• See also PhotoViewer on page 71 if the
disc contains both MP3 audio files and
JPEG picture files.
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
5
Use the MASTER VOLUME – / + button
TV CONTROL
(or the top panel VOLUME buttons) to
adjust the volume.
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
Button
What it does
ꢄ
Starts playback.
DVD and Video CD: If the display
shows Resume or Last Mem
playback starts from the resume
or last memory point (see also
Resume and Last Memory
below.)
23
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
Button
What it does
ꢋ
Pauses a disc that’s playing, or
restarts a paused disc.
• You may find with some DVD discs that
some playback controls don’t work in
certain parts of the disc. This is not a
malfunction.
ꢀ
Stops playback.
DVD and Video CD: The display
shows Resume. Press ꢀ again if
you want to cancel the resume
function. (See also Resume and
Last Memory below.)
• Track skip and number buttons for track
selection do not work with unfinalized CD-
R/RW discs.
Using the top panel controls
ꢅ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢍ
Press to start fast reverse
scanning. Press ꢄ (play) to
resume normal playback.
The ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE, ꢁ and ꢀ (stop)
buttons on the top panel work the same way
as the remote control equivalents.
Press to start fast forward
scanning. Press ꢄ (play) to
resume normal playback.
Resume and Last Memory
When you stop playback of a DVD or Video CD
disc, Resume is shown in the display indi-
cating that you can resume playback again
from that point.
Skips to the start of the current
track or chapter, then to previous
tracks/chapters.
If the disc tray is not opened, the next time you
start playback the display shows Resume and
playback resumes from the resume point.
Skips to the next track or chapter.
FOLDER+/– Skips to the next/previous folder
For DVD discs only: If you take the disc out of
the player, the play position is stored in
memory. When you load the disc next time,
the display shows Last Mem and you can
resume playback (this works for up to five
discs).
(SUB)
when playing a JPEG or MP3
disc.
Numbers
Use to enter a title/track/group/
chapter number. Press ENTER to
select (or wait a few seconds).
• If the disc is stopped, playback
starts from the selected title/
group (for DVD-Video/DVD-
Audio) or track number (for
SACD/CD/Video CD/Super VCD/
MP3).
If you want to clear the resume/last memory
point, press ꢀ (stop) while Resume or Last
Mem is displayed.
• If the disc is playing, playback
jumps to the start of the selected
chapter or track (within the
current group for DVD-Audio).
• When a Video CD is loaded, the Resume
point is lost if the system is switched off,
or switched to a function other than DVD
(CD).
• For the Last Memory function to work, you
must press ꢀ (stop) to stop playback
before opening the disc tray.
24
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
• Resume and Last Memory are not avail-
able with DVD-Audio discs.
Some movie formats are such that even
when played on a widescreen TV, black
bars are necessary at the top and bottom
of the screen. This is not a malfunction.
• The Last Memory function doesn’t work
with VR format DVD-RW discs.
• I have a standard (4:3) TV and set the
system to show widescreen DVDs in pan &
scan format, so why do I still get black bars
top and bottom with some discs?
• With MP3 format discs, playback does not
resume. Instead, playback begins of the
first track of the folder containing the file
that was playing when playback was
stopped.
Some discs override the display
preferences of the system, so even if you
have 4:3 (Pan & Scan) selected, those
discs will still be shown in letterbox
format. This is not a malfunction.
• After I load a DVD disc, it ejects
automatically after a few seconds!
• Why can’t I hear DVD-Audio and SACD
audio through the digital outputs?
Most likely, the disc is the wrong region
for your system. The region number
should be printed on the disc; check it
against the region number of the system
(which you can find on the rear panel).
See also DVD Video regions on page 78.
DVD-Audio and SACD audio is only
available through the analog outputs. This
is not a malfunction.
• My DVD-Audio disc starts playing, but then
suddenly stops!
If the region number is OK, it may be that
the disc is damaged or dirty. Clean the
disc and look for signs of damage. See
also Using and taking care of discs on
page 78.
The disc may have been illegally copied.
DVD disc menus
Many DVD-Video and DVD-Audio discs
contain menus from which you can select
what you want to watch or listen to. They may
give access to additional features, such as
subtitle and audio language selection, or
special features such as slideshows. See the
disc packaging for details.
• Why won’t the disc I loaded play?
First check that you loaded the disc the
right way up (label side up), and that it’s
clean and not damaged. See Using and
taking care of discs on page 78 for
information on cleaning discs.
Sometimes DVD menus are displayed
automatically when you start playback; others
only appear when you press DVD MENU or
TOP MENU.
If a disc loaded correctly won’t play, it’s
probably an incompatible format or disc
type, such as DVD-ROM. See General disc
compatibility on page 9 for more on disc
compatibility.
• I have a widescreen TV so why are there
black bars at the top and bottom of the
screen when I play some discs?
• Some DVD-Audio discs feature a bonus
group. To access this group you have to
input a password which you can find on
the disc packaging. See page 69 for more
information.
25
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
DVD MENU
RETURN
SOUND
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus
Some Video CD/Super VCDs have menus
from which you can choose what you want to
watch. These are called PBC (Playback
control) menus.
ENTER
MUTE
MASTER
VOLUME
You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD
without having to navigate the PBC menu by
pressing ꢀ (stop) then starting playback
using a number button to select a track,
rather than ꢄ(play) (or ꢁ on the top panel).
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢈ
SUBTITLE
ꢌ
ꢌ
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
ꢀ
3
SYSTEM
DVD MENU
RETURN
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
TUNE+
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ST–
ST+
8
9
ENTER
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
TUNE–
CLR
MUTE
SOUND
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
Button
What it does
CH
INPUT
VOL
Displays the ‘top menu’ of a DVD
disc—this varies with the disc.
TOP MENU
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
Displays a DVD disc menu—this
varies with the disc and may be
the same as the ‘top menu’.
DVD
MENU
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ
Moves the cursor around the
screen.
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
Selects the current menu option.
MAIN
SUB
ENTER
Returns to the previously
RETURN
displayed menu screen. On
some DVD-Audio discs featuring
browsable pictures, press to
display the browser screen.
Numbers
(MAIN)
Highlights a numbered menu
option (some discs only). Press
ENTER to select (or wait a few
seconds).
26
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
Listening to the radio
Button
What it does
The tuner can receive both FM and AM
broadcasts, and lets you memorize your
favorite stations so you don’t have to manually
tune in every time you want to listen.
Displays the PBC menu.
RETURN
Numbers
Selects a numbered menu
option.
ꢌ
Displays the previous menu page
(if there is one).
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
ꢍ
Displays the next menu page (if
there is one).
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
Press to select highlighted menu
option.
ENTER
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
1
If the system isn’t already on, press
ꢂ STANDBY/ON to switch on.
2
Press TUNER to switch to the tuner,
then press repeatedly to select the AM or
FM band.
The display indicates the tuner band and the
frequency.
3
Tune to a frequency.
There are three tuning modes—manual, auto,
and high-speed:
27
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
Getting started
• Manual tuning: Press TUNE +/–
repeatedly to change the displayed
frequency.
Memorizing stations
You can save up to 30 station presets so that
you always have easy access to your favorite
stations without having to tune in manually
each time.
• Auto tuning: Press and hold TUNE +/–
until the frequency display starts to move,
then release. The tuner will stop on the
next station it finds. Repeat to search for
other stations.
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
• High-speed tuning: Press and hold
TUNE +/– until the frequency display
starts to move rapidly. Keep the button
held down until you reach the frequency
you want. If necessary, fine tune the
frequency using the manual tuning
method.
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
Improving poor FM reception
If you’re listening to an FM station in stereo
but the reception is weak, you can improve
the sound quality by switching to mono.
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
1
2
3
Tune to an FM radio station.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
SUBTITLE
buttons to choose ‘FM Mode?’ then press
ENTER.
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
buttons to select ‘FM Mono’ then press
ENTER.
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
The mono indicator ( ) lights when the tuner
is in mono reception mode.
Select FM Auto above to switch back to auto-
1
Tune to an AM or FM radio station.
For the FM band, select mono or auto-stereo
reception as necessary. This setting is saved
along with the preset.
stereo mode (the stereo indicator ( ) lights
when receiving a stereo broadcast).
28
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting started
03
2
3
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
Listening to other sources
You can connect up to four external sources
(TV, satellite receiver, etc.) to this system,
including one digital source. See also
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to choose ‘St. Memory?’ then
press ENTER.
Connecting auxiliary components on page 72.
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select the station preset you
want.
There are 30 preset locations; each can store
one station preset.
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
5
Press ENTER to save the station preset.
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
• If the system is unplugged from the power
supply completely, saved stations will
remain for several days, after which you’ll
have to save them again.
1
If the system isn’t already on, press ꢂ
STANDBY/ON to switch on.
Also make sure that the external source (TV,
satellite receiver, etc.) is switched on.
2
Select the source you want to listen to.
• Press TV to select the TV input, or use the
LINE (L1/L2) button to select the LINE 1
ANA, LINE1 DIG or LINE 2 ANA input.
Listening to station presets
Make sure the TUNER function is
1
selected.
3
If necessary, start playback of the
2
Use the ST +/– buttons to select a
external source.
station preset.
29
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
Home theater sound
Chapter 4
Home theater sound
Using this system you can enjoy listening to
sources, analog or digital, in either stereo or
surround sound.
Listening in surround sound
You can listen to any source—stereo or
multichannel, analog or digital—in surround
sound. Surround sound is generated from
stereo sources (except SACD and DVD-Audio)
using one of the Dolby Pro Logic decoding
modes.
Auto listening mode
The Auto listening mode is the simplest way
to listen to any source as it was mastered: the
output from the speakers mirrors the
channels in the source material.
BASS MODE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
TOP MENU
2
ZOOM
1
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SETUP
SUBTITLE
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
HOME
MENU
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
8
9
3
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
CLR
4
ROOM SETUP
QUIET/
TIMER/
MAIN
SUB
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
•
Press SURROUND repeatedly to select
a listening mode (or press SURROUND
then use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons).
The listening mode choices that appear in the
display will vary according to the type of
source that’s playing.
•
Press AUTO to select the ‘Auto’
listening mode.
If the source is Dolby Digital or DTS, the
2DIGITAL or DTS indicator on the display
unit lights.
• Auto – Auto listening mode (see above)
• Dolby Digital / DTS – Dolby Digital or
DTS decoding (depending on the source).
For a multichannel source, this will be the
same as Auto.
• Any previously active Dolby Pro Logic or
Advanced Surround mode is canceled
when Auto listening mode is selected.
• Pro Logic – 4.1 channel surround sound
for use with any two-channel source
• PL II Movie – Pro Logic II 5.1 channel
surround sound, especially suited to
movie sources, for use with any two-
channel source
30
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Home theater sound
04
• PL II Music – Pro Logic II 5.1 channel
surround sound, especially suited to
music sources, for use with any two-
channel source (see also Dolby Pro Logic
II Music settings below)
1
With Dolby Pro Logic II Music mode
active, press SOUND.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘C Width’, ‘Dimen.’ or
‘Pnrm.’
• Stereo – See Listening in stereo below
• C Width (Center Width): Makes the
center channel wider (higher settings) or
narrower (lower settings)
• Dimen. (Dimension): Makes the sound
more distant (minus settings), or more
forward (positive settings)
• See also Using the Advanced Surround
effects on page 32, for further stereo and
surround playback options.
• Pnrm. (Panorama): Creates more
spacious surround sound
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to adjust the setting.
Center Width is adjustable between 0 and 7;
Dimension between –3 and +3. Panorama is
On or Off.
• You can’t use the Surround modes with
SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz PCM
sources.
• When headphones are connected, only
the Stereo option is available.
4
Press ENTER to confirm.
• When listening in Dolby Digital / DTS
mode, two-channel material will
automatically be played in surround
sound using Dolby Pro Logic decoding.
Listening in stereo
You can listen to any source—stereo or
multichannel, analog or digital—in stereo.
When playing a multichannel source, stereo
sound is created by downmixing all channels
to the front left/right speakers and the
subwooofer.
• Dolby Digital / DTS sources that use only
the center channel cannot be played back
in surround sound.
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings
When listening in Dolby Pro Logic II Music
mode, there are three further parameters you
can adjust: Center Width, Dimension, and
Panorama.
BASS MODE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
Default Settings:
C Width: 3
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
Dimen.: 0
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
Pnrm.: Off
•
Press SURROUND repeatedly until
‘Stereo’ shows in the display.
Any active Advanced Surround mode is
canceled.
31
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
Home theater sound
Using the Advanced Surround
effects
• See also Using the Advanced Surround
effects below, for further stereo and
surround playback options.
Advanced Surround effects can be used with
multichannel or stereo sources for a variety of
additional surround sound effects.
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢄ
ꢀ
Listening with headphones
When headphones are connected, only the
Stereo (default) and Phones Surround
(virtual surround sound for headphones)
modes are available.
ꢅ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
•
With headphones connected, press
ENTER
ADVANCED to select ‘Phones Surround’ or
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
SURROUND to select ‘Stereo’.
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
•
Press ADVANCED to select an
Advanced Surround mode (or press
ADVANCED then use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/
down) bottons).
Press repeatedly to select from:
• Adv. Music – Gives a concert hall-type
sound
• Adv. Movie – Gives a movie theater-type
sound
• Expanded – Creates an extra wide stereo
field
• TV Surr. – Designed for mono or stereo TV
broadcasts and other sources
32
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Home theater sound
04
• Sports – Designed for sports and other
programs based on commentary
Enhancing dialogue
• Default setting: Dialog Off
• Game – Creates surround sound from
video game sources
The Dialogue Enhancement feature is
designed to make the dialog stand out from
other background sounds in a TV or movie
soundtrack.
• ExPwrSurr. (Extra Power Surround) –
Gives additional energy and width to
stereo sources
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
ADVANCED
• Virtual – Creates the impression of
surround sound from just the front
speakers
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
• 5ch Stereo – Designed to give powerful
surround sound to stereo music sources
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
• You can’t use the Advanced Surround
modes with SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz
PCM sources.
•
Press DIALOGUE to select the amount
dialog enhancement.
Press repeatedly to select from:
• You can use any of the above Advanced
Surround modes with any type of source.
The descriptions are given only as a guide.
• Dialog Off – No dialog enhancement
• Dialog Mid – Moderate dialog
enhancement
• When headphones are connected, only
the Phones Surround option is available.
• Dialog Max – Strong dialog
enhancement
Adjusting the Advanced Surround
effect level
You can emphasize or reduce the effect of the
Advanced Surround modes as you like. For
each Advanced Surround mode you can set
the effect level independently.
• You can’t use Dialog Enhancement with
SACD, DVD-Audio and 96 kHz PCM
sources.
1
With one of the Advanced Surround
modes active, press SOUND.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Effect’.
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to adjust the effect level.
The effect level can be adjusted from 10 (min)
to 90 (max).
4
Press ENTER to confirm.
33
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
Home theater sound
Listening with a virtual
Using Quiet and Midnight
surround back speaker
listening modes
• Default setting: Vir. SB Off
• Default setting: Off
The Virtual Surround Back feature can be
used when listening in surround sound to
simulate an added surround back channel. In
a real theater the surround back speaker
would be directly behind you, creating more
cohesive and realistic surround sound.
The Quiet listening feature reduces excessive
bass or treble in a sound source. You can use
this feature if the music is a little bit harsh and
you would like a smoother sound.
The Midnight listening feature allows you to
hear effective surround sound of movies at
low volume levels. The effect automatically
adjusts according to the volume at which
you’re listening.
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
3
CLR
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
•
Press VIRTUAL SB repeatedly to switch
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
between ‘Vir. SB On’ and ‘Vir. SB Off’.
•
Press QUIET/MIDNIGHT repeatedly to
switch between ‘Quiet’, ‘Midnight’ and
‘Off’.
• You can’t use Virtual Surround Back
when listening in Stereo or Virtual
listening modes.
• You can’t use Virtual Surround Back
when headphones are connected.
When the headphones are connected, you
can't set Quiet/Midnight in the following
cases:
• If there is no surround channel, Virtual
Surround Back has no effect.
• When an SACD or DVD-Audio disc is
loaded.
• You can’t use the Virtual Surround
Back effect with SACD, DVD-Audio and
96 kHz PCM sources.
34
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Home theater sound
04
Adjusting the bass and treble Boosting the bass level
• Default setting: Treble: 0, Bass: 0
There are three bass modes you can use to
enhance the bass in a source.
Use the bass and treble controls to adjust the
overall tone. Bass and treble adjustment is
not possible when the Quiet or Midnight
modes are active.
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
3
SYSTEM
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢄ
ꢀ
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ꢅ
ꢈ
8
9
ꢌ
ꢌ
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
•
Press BASS MODE repeatedly to
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
choose an option that fits the source
you’re listening to.
MASTER
VOLUME
• Music – Can be used with music to give a
deeper bass sound
1
2
Press SOUND.
• Cinema – Good for action movies or
movies with lots of sound effects
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Bass’ or ‘Treble’.
• P. Bass – Can be used with music sources
to bring the beat of the music (or
soundtrack) to the forefront
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to adjust the sound.
The bass and treble can be adjusted from –3
to +3.
• Off
4
Press ENTER to confirm.
• You can’t use the bass mode with SACD
and DVD-Audio sources.
• You can't use the bass mode when the
headphones are connected.
When the headphones are connected, you
can't adjust treble/bass in the following
cases:
• When Recording Mode is ON
• When an SACD or DVD-Audio disc is
loaded.
35
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
Home theater sound
Muting the sound
Use the MUTE button if you need to
momentarily turn off all sound from the
speakers.
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
•
Press MUTE to mute the volume.
To cancel, adjust the volume or press MUTE
again.
36
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
CPhlaapteyr i5ng discs
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Disc
Introduction
Navigator’ from the on-screen display.
Alternatively, if a VR format DVD-RW, CD,
Video CD/Super VCD or MP3/JPEG disc is
loaded, you can press DVD MENU, which
takes you straight to the Disc Navigator
screen.
Most of the features described in this chapter
make use of on-screen displays. For an expla-
nation of how to navigate these, see Using the
on-screen displays on page 21.
Many of the functions covered in this chapter
apply to DVD and SACD discs, Video CD/
Super VCDs, CDs and MP3/JPEG discs,
although the exact operation of some varies
slightly with the kind of disc loaded.
HOME MENU
DVD
Play Mode
Video Adjust
Some DVD discs restrict the use of some
functions (random or repeat, for example).
This is not a malfunction.
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
When playing Video CD/Super VCDs, some of
the functions are not available during PBC
playback. If you want to use them, start the
disc playing using a number button to select
a track.
2
Select what you want to play.
Depending on the type of disc you have loaded,
the Disc Navigator looks slightly different.
The screen for DVD-Video discs shows the
titles on the left and the chapters on the right.
Select a title, or a chapter within a title.
• To access functions printed in green on
the remote, move the slider switch from
MAIN to SUB.
Disc Navigator
Title 1-10
Chapter 1-3
DVD
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Using the Disc Navigator to
browse the contents of a disc
Use the Disc Navigator to browse through the
contents of a disc to find the part you want to
play. You can use the Disc Navigator when a
disc is playing or stopped.
For DVD-Audio, select a group or a track
within a group.
Disc Navigator
Group 1-3
Track 1-36
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
DVD-Audio
37
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
For SACD, select a track within the current
playback area.
The screen for an MP3 disc shows the folder
names on the left and the track names on the
right (note that if there are more than 16
folders or names that contain accented or
non-roman characters, tracks and folders
may show up with generic names – F_033,
T_035, etc.).
Disc Navigator
Track 1-14
2ch Area
Track 001
Track 002
Track 003
Track 004
Track 005
Track 006
Track 007
Track 008
Select a folder, or a track within a folder.
Disc Navigator
Folder 1-17
Track 1-10
For a VR (Video Recording) mode DVD-RW
disc select beween the Playlist and Original
areas of the disc, or a title. Press ꢃ (cursor
right) to preview the title.
MP3
001. ACP
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
004. Live
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
007.Thermo
008. Missing Man
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
• It’s not possible to switch between Orig-
inal and Playlist during playback.
Playback starts after you press ENTER.
• Not all VR format DVD-RW discs have a
Playlist.
Disc Navigator
Title(1-3)
DVD-RW
Original
01. 3/31 FIRST LEAGUE
02. 4/28 SECOND LEAGUE
03. 4/29 FINAL ROUND
• The Disc Navigator is not available unless
there is a disc loaded.
Play List
• It’s not possible to use the Disc Navigator
when playing a Video CD/Super VCD in
PBC mode, or an unfinalized CD-R/RW
disc.
The screen for CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs
shows a list of tracks. (The screen below
shows a CD loaded.)
• Another way to find a particular place on
a disc is to use one of the search modes.
See Searching a disc on page 46.
Disc Navigator
Track 1-10
Scanning discs
CD
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
You can fast-scan discs forward or backward
at various different speeds.
1
During playback, press ꢅ or ꢈ to
start scanning.
2
Press repeatedly to increase the scan-
ning speed.
• MP3 tracks can only be scanned at one
speed.
• The scanning speed is shown on-screen.
38
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
3
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ
4
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ
(play).
(play).
• Sound can be heard while scanning audio
CDs, SACD and MP3 discs.
• Video CD/Super VCD only supports
forward slow motion playback.
• When scanning a Video CD/Super VCD or
MP3 track, playback automatically
resumes at the end or beginning of the
track.
• The picture quality during slow motion
playback is not as good as during normal
playback.
• Depending on the disc, normal playback
may automatically resume when a new
chapter is reached.
• There is no sound while scanning DVD-
Videos and Video CD/Super VCDs, and no
subtitles while scanning DVD-Videos.
• Depending on the disc, normal playback
may automatically resume when a new
chapter is reached on a DVD-Video disc.
Frame advance/frame reverse
You can advance or back up DVD-Video or VR
format DVD-RW discs frame-by-frame. With
Video CD/Super VCDs, you can only use
frame advance.
Playing in slow motion
You can play DVD-Video, DVD-R/RW and
Video CD/Super VCDs at four different
forward slow motion speeds. DVD-Videos and
DVD-R/RW discs can also be played at two
reverse speeds.
1
During playback, press ꢋ (pause)
(ꢁ on the top panel).
2
Press ꢆ/ꢇ or ꢉ/ꢊ to reverse or
advance a frame at a time.
3
To resume normal playback, press ꢄ
1
During playback, press ꢋ (pause)
(play) (ꢁ on the top panel).
(ꢁ on the top panel).
2
Press and hold ꢆ/ꢇ or ꢉ/ꢊ until
slow motion playback starts.
• The slow motion speed is shown on-
screen.
• The picture quality when using frame
reverse is not as good as frame advance.
• There is no sound during slow motion
playback.
• Depending on the disc, normal playback
may automatically resume when a new
chapter is reached.
3
Press repeatedly to change the slow
motion speed.
• The slow motion speed is displayed on-
screen.
• When changing direction with a DVD
disc, the picture may ‘move’ in an unex-
pected way. This is not a malfunction.
39
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
4
Press ENTER on ‘B(End Point)’ to set
Looping a section of a disc
the loop end point.
The A-B Repeat function allows you to specify
two points (A and B) within a track (CD and
Video CD) or title (DVD-Video and DVD-RW)
that form a loop which is played over and over.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
• You can’t use A-B Repeat with MP3 discs,
DVD-Audio, SACD, Super VCD discs,
Video CDs in PBC mode or unfinalized
CD-R/RW discs.
After pressing ENTER, playback jumps back
to the start point and plays the loop.
• The minimum loop time is 2 seconds.
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Play Mode’.
5
To resume normal playback, select
‘Off’ from the menu.
2
Select ‘A-B Repeat’ from the list of
functions on the left.
Using repeat play
Play Mode
There are various repeat play options,
depending on the kind of disc loaded. It’s also
possible to use repeat play together with
program play to repeat the tracks/chapters in
the program list (see Creating a program list
on page 43).
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
3
Press ENTER on ‘A(Start Point)’ to set
the loop start point.
• You can’t use Repeat play with Video CD/
Super VCDs in PBC mode, or unfinalized
CD-R/RW discs.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
40
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
For SACDs, CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs,
select Disc Repeat or Track Repeat (or
Repeat Off).
Using the OSD
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Play Mode’.
Play Mode
2
Select ‘Repeat’ from the list of
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Disc Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
functions on the left.
Random
Play Mode
Program
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Repeat
Chapter Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Program
For MP3 discs, select Disc Repeat, Folder
Search Mode
Repeat or Track Repeat (or Repeat Off).
Play Mode
3
Select a repeat play option.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Disc Repeat
Folder Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
If program play is active, select Program
Repeat to repeat the program list, or Repeat
Off to cancel.
Random
Program
Search Mode
For DVD-Video and DVD-RW discs, select
Title Repeat or Chapter Repeat (or Repeat
Off).
Using the display unit
During playback, press REPEAT to
select a repeat play option.
Press repeatedly until the repeat play option
you want is shown in the display.
Play Mode
•
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Repeat
Chapter Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
The repeat options are the same as those
available from the OSD (see above).
For DVD-Audio discs, select Group Repeat or
Track Repeat (or Repeat Off).
Play Mode
• If you’ve created a program list, Program
Repeat is also available.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Group Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
• During playback, you can cancel repeat
Random
play by pressing CLR.
Program
Search Mode
• You can’t use repeat and random play at
the same time.
• If you switch camera angle during repeat
play, repeat play is canceled.
41
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
For DVD-Audio discs, select Random Group
or Random Track (or Random Off).
Using random play
Use the random play function to play titles or
chapters (DVD-Video), groups or tracks (DVD-
Audio), or tracks (SACD, CD, Video CD/Super
VCD and MP3 discs) in a random order.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random Group
Random Track
Random Off
You can set the random play option when a
disc is playing or stopped.
Random
Program
Search Mode
For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select On
or Off to switch random play on or off.
• You can’t use random play with VR format
DVD-RW discs, Video CD/Super VCDs
playing in PBC mode or while a DVD disc
menu is being displayed.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
On
Off
Random
Using the OSD
Program
Search Mode
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Play Mode’.
2
Select ‘Random’ from the list of
For MP3 discs, select Random All (all folders)
or Random Track (current folder only), (or
Random Off).
functions on the left.
Play Mode
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random Title
Random Chapter
Random Off
Random
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random All
Random Track
Random Off
Program
Search Mode
Random
Program
Search Mode
3
Select a random play option.
For DVD-Video discs, select Random Title or
Random Chapter, (or Random Off).
Play Mode
• You can also use the RANDOM button on
the remote to select a random play mode.
The random mode is indicated in the
display unit and on-screen. The random
modes available are the same as when
choosing from the Play Mode menu.
Press ENTER to start random play.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random Title
Random Chapter
Random Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
• To stop the disc and cancel random play-
back, press ꢀ (stop).
42
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
• To cancel random playback without stop-
ping playback, press CLR. The disc will
play to the end, then stop.
3
Select ‘Create/Edit’ from the list of
program options.
Play Mode
• During random play, the ꢌ and ꢍ
buttons function a little differently to
normal: ꢌ returns to the beginning of
the current track/chapter. You can't go
back further than this. ꢍ selects
another track/chapter at random from
those remaining.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Create/Edit
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
Random
Program
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
• You can't use random play together with
program or repeat play.
The Program edit screen that appears
depends on the kind of disc loaded.
On the left side is the program list, then to the
right is a list of titles (if a DVD-Video disc is
loaded), groups (for DVD-Audio), tracks (for
SACDs, CDs and Video CD/Super VCD), or
folder names (for MP3 discs). On the far right
is a list of chapters (for DVD-Video) or track
names (for MP3).
Creating a program list
This feature lets you program the play order of
titles/groups/chapters/folders tracks on a
disc.
4
Select a title, chapter, group, folder or
track for the current step in the program
list.
For a DVD-Video disc, you can add a whole
title, or a chapter within a title to the program
list.
• You can’t use Program play with VR
format DVD-RW discs, Video CD/Super
VCDs playing in PBC mode, or while a
DVD disc menu is being displayed.
• To add a title, select the title.
Using the OSD
Program
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
Program Step
Title 1~38
Chapter 1~4
and select ‘Play Mode’.
01. 01
02.
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Chapter 004
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of
03.
04.
functions on the left.
05.
06.
07.
Play Mode
08.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Create/Edit
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
Random
Program
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
43
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
• To add a chapter, first highlight the title,
then press ꢃ (cursor right) and select a
chapter from the list.
For an SACD, CD or Video CD/Super VCD,
select a track to add to the program list.
Program
Program Step
Track 1~12
Program
01. 04
02.
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
Program Step
Title 1-38
Chapter 1-4
01. 01-003
02.
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Chapter 004
03.
04.
03.
05.
04.
06.
05.
07.
06.
08.
07.
08.
For an MP3 disc, you can add a whole folder,
or a track within a folder to the program list.
For a DVD-Audio disc, you can add a whole
group, or a track within a group to the
program list.
• To add a folder, select the folder.
Program
• To add a group, select the group.
Program Step
Folder 1-6
Track 1-10
01. 001
02.
001. ACP
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
Program
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
Program Step
Group 1~38
Track 1~4
03.
01. 01
02.
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
Group 04
Group 05
Group 06
Group 07
Group 08
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
04.
004. Live
05.
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
03.
06.
04.
07.
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
05.
08.
06.
07.
08.
• To add a track, first find the folder, then
press ꢃ (cursor right) and select a track
name from the list.
• To add a track, first highlight the group,
then press ꢃ (cursor right) and select a
track from the list.
Program
Program Step
Folder 1-6
Track 1-10
01. 001-003
001. ACP
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
Program
02.
03.
04.
05.
06.
07.
08.
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
Program Step
Group 1-38
Track 1-4
01. 01-003
02.
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
Group 04
Group 05
Group 06
Group 07
Group 08
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
004. Live
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
03.
04.
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
05.
06.
07.
08.
After pressing ENTER to select the title/
chapter/group/folder/track, the step number
automatically moves down one.
5
Repeat step 4 to build up a program
list.
A program list can contain up to 24 titles/
chapters/group/folders/tracks.
44
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
6
To play the program list, press ꢄ
6
To add a step to the end of the
(play).
program list, highlight the next free step
then select a title/chapter/group/folder/
track to add.
Program play remains active until you turn off
program play (see below), erase the program
list (see below), eject the disc or switch off the
player or switched to a function other than
DVD (CD).
• To save your program list and exit the
program edit screen without starting play-
back, press HOME MENU.
• To save your program list and exit the
program edit screen without starting play-
back, press HOME MENU. (Don’t press
RETURN – your program list won’t be
saved.)
• If you want to exit the program edit screen
without saving the changes you made,
press RETURN.
Other functions available from the OSD
program menu
As well as creating and editing a program list,
you can start program play, cancel program
play, erase the program list, and memorize a
program list from the Play Mode menu.
• During program play, press ꢍto skip to
the next program step.
• Press CLR during playback to switch off
program play. Press while stopped to
erase the program list.
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
Editing a program list using the OSD
After creating a program list, you can add,
delete and change steps.
and select ‘Play Mode’.
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of
functions on the left.
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Play Mode’.
Play Mode
2
Select ‘Program’ from the list of
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Create/Edit
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
functions on the left.
Random
Program
3
Select ‘Create/Edit’ from the list of
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
program options.
4
To clear a step, highlight the step
number and press CLR.
3
Select a program play function.
• Create/Edit – See above
5
To insert a step in the middle of the
program list, highlight the step where you
want the new step to appear, then select
a title/chapter/group/folder/track to add.
After pressing ENTER, the new step is
inserted into the list.
• Playback Start – Starts playback of a
saved program list
• Playback Stop – Turns off program play,
but does not erase the program list
• Program Delete – Erases the program
list and turns off program play
45
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
• Program Memory (DVD-Video only) –
Select On to save the program list for the
disc loaded. (Select Off to cancel the
program memory for the disc loaded)
4
To play the program list, press ꢄ
(play).
Program play remains active until you press
ꢀ (stop), clear the playlist (see below), eject
the disc or switch off the player.
Clearing the program list
You must clear the program list to program a
new one.
• Program lists are saved for the DVD disc
loaded. When you load a disc with a saved
program list, program play is automati-
cally turned on.
1
2
If a disc is playing, press ꢀ (stop).
• You can save program lists for up to 24
discs. After that, the oldest one is
replaced with the new one saved.
Press CLR.
Searching a disc
You can search DVD-Video discs by title or
chapter number, or by time. DVD-Audio discs
can be searched by group or track, or by page.
SACDs, CD/Super VCDs can be searched by
track number, and Video CDs by track
number or time. MP3 discs can be searched
by folder or track number.
Using the unit display
Even though the OSD is available for SACDs,
CDs and MP3 discs, the Display unit provides
enough information to make a program list
easily. If a disc is playing, stop it first.
1
Press PROGRAM.
You’re prompted to enter a track or folder for
the first step in the program list.
1
During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Play Mode’.
2
Select ‘Search Mode’ from the list of
P - 0 0
0 0 0
functions on the left.
The search options that appear depend on the
kind of disc loaded. The screen below shows
the DVD-Video search options.
2
Use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) to select a
track or a folder, then press ENTER.
P - 0 1
5 3 7
Play Mode
• For MP3 discs only: To select an individual
track within a folder, use the ꢀ/ꢁ(cursor
up/down) buttons to select the folder,
then press ꢃ, then use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/
down) to select a track. Press ENTER.
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Search
Chapter Search
Time Search
Random
Program
Search Mode
Wait for the display to prompt you after
completing each selection. If you make a
mistake, press CLR to delete the last (most
recently) programmed track.
3
Repeat step 2 to build up a program
list.
A program list can contain up to 24 steps.
46
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
3
4
Select a search mode.
Playing DVD-Audio ‘Bonus
Groups’
Use the number buttons to enter a
title, group, chapter, folder or track
number, or a time or a page.
Some DVD-Audio discs have an extra ‘bonus’
group that requires a 4-digit key number to
access. See the disc packaging for details
and the key number. When you try and play
the bonus group, the player will automatically
ask you for the key number.
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Search
Input Chapter
Chapter Search
Time Search
0
0
1
Random
Program
1
Use the number buttons to enter the
Search Mode
4-digit key number.
• It’s also possible to enter the key number
from the Options menu. See page 69.
• For a time search, enter the number of
minutes and seconds into the currently
playing title (DVD-Video/DVD-RW) or
track (Video CD) you want playback to
resume from.
For example, press 4, 5, 0, 0 to have play-
back start from 45 minutes into the disc.
For 1 hour, 20 minutes and 30 seconds,
press 8, 0, 3, 0.
Switching subtitles
Some DVD-Video discs have subtitles in one
or more languages; the disc box will usually
tell you which subtitle languages are avail-
able. You can switch subtitle language during
playback.
•
Press SUBTITLE repeatedly to select a
subtitle option.
• Some DVD-Audio discs feature pages of
browsable pictures. Enter the page
number you want.
Current / Total
1/2
Subtitle
English
5
Press ENTER to start playback.
• Some discs only allow you to change
subtitle language from the disc menu.
Press TOP MENU to access.
• You can only use time search with DVD-
Video and Video CD discs.
• The disc must be playing in order to use
time search.
• To set subtitle preferences, see Subtitle
Language on page 65.
• Search functions are not available with
Video CD/Super VCDs in PBC mode, or
unfinalized CD-R/RW discs.
Switching DVD-Video audio
language
• With more than two SACD discs you may
not be able to select the first track of discs
after the second disc.
When playing a DVD-Video disc recorded with
dialog in two or more languages, you can
switch audio language during playback.
47
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
•
Press AUDIO repeatedly to select an
•
Press AUDIO repeatly to select an
audio language option.
audio channel option.
Current /Total
1/2
Audio
French
Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH
Audio
Stereo
Zooming the screen
Using the zoom feature you can magnify a
part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, while
watching a DVD-Video, DVD-Audio or Video
CD/Super VCD.
• Some discs only allow you to change
audio language from the disc menu.
Press TOP MENU to access.
• To set audio language preferences, see
Audio Language on page 65.
1
During playback, use the ZOOM
button to select the zoom factor.
• Normal
Switching DVD-Audio audio
channels
• 2x
• 4x
Depending on the disc, you may be able to
switch channels when playing DVD-Audio
discs—see the disc box for details.
Normal
1
Press AUDIO repeatedly to select an
audio channel option.
Digital Out Converted
Linear PCM 192kHz24bit
2CH
Zoom 2x
Zoom 2x
Audio
1
When you change the audio channel, play-
back restarts from the beginning of the
current track.
Zoom 4x
Zoom 4x
• Some discs only allow you to change
audio channel from the disc menu. Press
TOP MENU to access.
• Since DVD-Video, DVD-Audio and Video
CD/Super VCD have a fixed resolution,
picture quality will deteriorate, especially
at 4x zoom. This is not a malfunction.
• To set audio language preferences, see
Audio Language on page 65.
2
Use the cursor buttons to change the
Switching Video CD/Super
VCD audio channel
zoomed area.
You can change the zoom factor and the
zoomed area freely during playback.
When playing a Video CD/Super VCD you can
switch between stereo, just the left channel or
just the right channel.
48
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
• If the navigation square at the top of the
screen disappears, press ZOOM again to
display it.
• DVD-Video displays
Play
DVD
ꢄ
Current / Total Elapsed
11/38 2.05
Remain
4.57
Total
7.02
Title
French
Audio Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH
English
Subtitle
1
Angle
Play
DVD
ꢄ
• We do not recommend using DVD disc
menus when the screen is zoomed as
menu options will not be highlighted.
Current / Total Elapsed
11/38 2.05
Remain
4.57
Total
7.02
Chapter
Tr. Rate
8.6Mbps
• If you are displaying subtitles, these will
disappear when the screen is zoomed.
They will reappear when you return the
screen to normal.
• DVD-Audio displays
Play
DVD-Audio
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/14
Elapsed
3.20
Remain
2.41
Total
6.01
Track
Audio
- -
1
1
Linear PCM
Subtitle
Angle
192kHz 24bit 2/0CH
Switching camera angles
-Audio
DVD
Play
ꢄ
Some DVD-Video discs feature scenes shot
from two or more angles—check the disc box
for details.
Current / Total
1/3
Elapsed
3.21
Remain
53.20
Total
56.41
Group
Tr. Rate
:
9.5Mbps
• VR format DVD-RW displays
When a multi-angle scene is playing, a
icon appears on screen to let you know that
other angles are available (this can be
switched off if you prefer—see Angle Indicator
on page 67).
Play
Title
DVD-RW
Original
Elapsed
0.08
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/32
Remain
30.22
Total
30.30
1
- -
Audio Dolby Digital
2/0CH
Subtitle
•
During playback (or when paused),
Play
DVD-RW
Original
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/1
press ANGLE to switch angle.
Chapter
Tr. Rate
4.3Mbps
Displaying disc information
• SACD displays
Various track, chapter and title information,
as well as the video transmission rate for DVD
discs, can be displayed on-screen while a disc
is playing.
Play
SACD
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/14
Elapsed
0.13
Remain
4.21
Total
4.34
Track
(During multichannel playback only)
Play
SACD
Elapsed
0.22
ꢄ
OSD disc information
Current / Total
1/9
Remain
3.38
Total
4.00
Track
3/2.1CH
•
To show/switch the information
Audio
displayed, press DISPLAY.
When a disc is playing, the information
appears at the top of the screen. Keep
pressing DISPLAY to change the displayed
information.
Play
Disc
SACD
ꢄ
Elapsed
0.05
Remain
73.00
Total
73.05
49
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
Playing discs
• CD and Video CD displays
Play
CD
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/16
Elapsed
1.07
Remain
4.40
Total
5.47
Track
Play
Disc
CD
ꢄ
Elapsed
28.00
Remain
30.20
Total
58.20
• (During PBC playback only.)
Play
VCD
ꢄ
• Super VCD displays
Play
CD
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/16
Elapsed
1.07
Track
• MP3 disc displays
Play
MP3
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/17
Elapsed
0.18
Remain
12.42
Total
13.00
Track
Track Name
Outernational
Play
MP3
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/7
Folder
Folder Name ACP
• JPEG disc displays
Play
JPEG
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/40
File
File Name
FL000001
Play
JPEG
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/6
Folder
Folder Name Holiday
• You can see disc information (number of
titles/chapters, tracks, groups, folders
and so on) from the Disc Navigator
screen. See Using the Disc Navigator to
browse the contents of a disc on page 37.
50
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Playing discs
05
Display unit information
• Video CD displays
Limited disc information also appears in the
display unit. Press DISPLAY to change the
displayed information.
Track no.
Elapsed disc time
4
11 1 6
Remaining disc time
5 3 1 5
3 2 0
Disc
• DVD-Video / DVD-RW displays
Title no.
Track no.
Remaining track time
2
2
8 4 9
4
Chapter no.
Elapsed title time
• Super VCD displays
Title no.
2
2
TTL 1 0 7 0 0
0 4 2
Track no.
Elapsed track time
Remaining title time
4
1 1 6
Title no.
2
• MP3 disc displays
Chapter no.
Remaining chapter
time
Track no.
Elapsed track time
2
0 3 5
Track name
E V E R Y B O D
B E S T _ O F _
• DVD-Audio displays
Group no.
Folder name
2
2
2
2
8 4 9
Track no.
Elapsed track time
• JPEG disc displays
Group no.
Track no.
2
3 1 5
File name
T I G E R _ 0 1
Remaining track time
Folder name
Group no.
Remaining group time
Z O O _ T R I P
GRP 1 4 7 0 0
• SACD / CD displays
Track no.
Elapsed track time
4
4
1 1 6
3 2 0
Track no.
Remaining track time
Remaining disc time
5 3 1 5
Disc
51
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
06
Viewing JPEG discs
Chapter 6
Viewing JPEG discs
Playing a JPEG slideshow
After loading a CD/CD-R/RW containing
• The ꢋ, ANGLE and ZOOM buttons do not
work while the display shows Loading.
JPEG pictures, press ꢄ to start a slideshow
from the first folder/picture on the disc. The
player displays the pictures in each folder in
alphabetical order.
• The time it takes for the player to load a file
increases with large file sizes.
Pictures are automatically adjusted so that
they fill as much of the screen as possible (if
the aspect ratio of the picture is different to
your TV screen you may notice black bars at
the sides, or at the top and bottom of the
screen).
• Up to 999 files are viewable on a disc. If
there are more files than this on a disc,
only the first 999 files are viewable.
Using the JPEG Disc Navigator
and Photo Browser
While the slideshow is running:
Use the JPEG Disc Navigator to find a
particular folder or picture by filename on the
disc in the play position; use the Photo
Browser to find a picture within a folder by
thumbnail image.
Button
What it does
ꢋ
Pauses the slideshow; press
again to restart.
ꢌ
Displays the previous picture.
Displays the next picture.
1
Press DVD MENU to display the Disc
ꢍ
Navigator screen.
ANGLE
Pauses the slideshow and
rotates the currently displayed
picture 90º clockwise. Press ꢄ
(play) to restart slideshow).
Disc Navigator
Folder 1-2
File 1-40
001. FL000001
002. FL000002
003. FL000003
004. FL000004
005. FL000005
006. FL000006
007. FL000007
008. FL000008
JPEG
001. F_001
002. F_002
ZOOM
Pauses the slideshow and zooms
the screen (see below). Press ꢄ
(play) to restart slideshow).
Displays the Disc Navigator
screen (see below).
DVD
MENU
The left column shows the folders on the disc,
the right column shows the files in a folder.
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to
Skip to the next/previous folder
when playing a JPEG disc.
FOLDER +/
FOLDER –
navigate.
When a file is highlighted, a thumbnail image
is displayed.
52
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Viewing JPEG discs
06
• When a folder is highlighted you can
press ENTER to open the Photo Browser
screen for that folder. See below for more
on using the Photo Browser.
1
During sldeshow playback, use the
ZOOM button to select the zoom factor.
• Normal
• 2x
• 4x
3
To resume the slideshow from the
highlighted file, press ENTER.
Normal
Using the Photo Browser
The Photo Browser displays nine thumbnail
images at a time from the current folder.
1
From the Disc Navigator screen,
Zoom 2x
Zoom 4x
highlight a folder to display then press
ENTER.
The Photo Browser screen opens with the first
nine pictures displayed as thumbnails.
Photo Browser
2 / 40 Live at Soft
• The slideshow is paused when the screen
is zoomed.
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to
• Since JPEG pictures have a fixed
resolution, picture quality may
deteriorate, especially at 4x zoom. This is
not a malfunction.
highlight a thumbnail picture.
• Use the track skip buttons (ꢌ and ꢍ)
to see the previous / next page of
thumbnails. Keep the button pressed if
you want to skip several pages; release
when you reach the page you want.
2
Use the cursor buttons (ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ) to
change the zoomed area.
You can change the zoom factor and the
zoomed area freely.
• To return to the Disc Navigator screen,
press RETURN.
3
To resume the slideshow, press ꢄ
3
Press ENTER to display the selected
(play).
thumbnail full size on screen.
The slideshow resumes from the selected
picture.
Zooming the screen
Using the zoom feature you can magnify a
part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, while
viewing pictures from a JPEG disc.
53
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
07
Using the timer
Chapter 7
Using the timer
1
Select the source you want played.
Setting the wake-up timer
For example, press TUNER to select the radio
as your source.
Use the wake-up timer to set the system to
switch on at any time and start playing
whatever source you want.
2
Prepare the source.
For example, tune in the radio station you
want to wake up to.
3
Set the volume.
• The clock must be set to the correct time
for the wake-up timer to work properly
(see Setting the clock on page 19).
4
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the
timer menu.
5
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
STANDBY/ON
buttons to select ‘Wake-Up?’ then press
ENTER.
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
6
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
ꢃ
ꢋ
buttons to select ‘TimerEdit?’ then press
ENTER.
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
7
Set the switch-on time.
DVD MENU
RETURN
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons to set
the hour, then press ENTER. Set the minute in
the same way, pressing ENTER when you’re
done.
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
8
Set the switch-off time.
MASTER
VOLUME
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons to set
the hour, then press ENTER. Set the minute in
the same way, pressing ENTER when you’re
done.
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
After pressing ENTER this last time, the wake-
up indicator lights, and the switch-on, switch-
off times, the function (DVD/CD, etc.) and
volume are confirmed in the display.
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
9
Switch the system into standby mode.
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
The wake-up timer will not work if the system
is left on!
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
54
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the timer
07
• You can check the timer settings in
standby by pressing TIMER/CLOCK twice.
(Press TIMER/CLOCK once to display the
current time.)
Turning the wake-up timer on/off
If the wake-up timer is on, it will switch on the
system everyday at the time you have set.
1
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the
timer menu.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Wake-Up?’ then press
ENTER.
3
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Timer On?’ or ‘Timer
Off?’.
• You must have the timer set (see above) to
select ON. The wake-up timer switches on
and off according to your previous
settings.
4
Press ENTER.
• The wake-up timer will automatically be
canceled if the clock is reset.
55
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
07
Using the timer
1
Press TIMER/CLOCK twice to reach the
Setting the sleep timer
timer menu.
The sleep timer switches off the system after
a specified time so you can fall asleep without
worrying about it.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Sleep?’ then press
ENTER.
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select a switch-off time then
press ENTER.
Choose between the following options:
• If you set the sleep timer while either the
wake-up timer is active, the earlier switch
off time takes priority.
• Sleep Auto – System switches off
automatically after the currently playing
SACD, CD, Video CD/Super VCD or MP3
disc has finished.
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
• Sleep 90 – System switches off after 90
minutes
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
• Sleep 60 – System switches off after an
hour
ꢌ
ꢌ
• Sleep 30 – System switches off after 30
DVD MENU
RETURN
minutes
ENTER
• Sleep Off – cancels the sleep timer
MUTE
SOUND
4
To check how much time is left, repeat
steps 1 and 2.
MASTER
VOLUME
The remaining time is displayed momentarily.
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
• Sleep Auto will not work with Video CD/
Super VCDs during PBC playback or CDs
in repeat play.
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
56
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Surround sound setup
08
CShuaprterr o8 und sound setup
Setting up surround sound
The Room Setup feature (page 20) is
• When you change speaker distance and
designed to give you a basic surround sound
setup, however you can make the more
detailed settings that may improve the
surround sound in your listening room.
channel level settings, these settings will
override settings you made in the Room
Setup.
1
2
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
STANDBY/ON
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
buttons to choose the setting you want to
adjust.
The current setting is shown for each option
as you cycle through the display. See below
for a full list and description of each.
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
DVD MENU
RETURN
buttons to adjust the setting.
ENTER
4
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to make other
MUTE
SOUND
settings.
MASTER
VOLUME
5
When you’re done, press ENTER to
leave the System Setup menu.
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
• The System Setup menu is exited
automatically after 5 minutes of inactivity.
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
System Setup menu options
Below are all the available settings in the
setup menu. The first setting in each section
is the default. See also the notes in each
section for additional information about the
settings.
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
57
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
08
Surround sound setup
Front speakers distance setting
Specifies the distance from your listening
position to the front speakers:
Dual mono setting
Specifies how dual mono encoded Dolby
Digital or DTS soundtracks should be played.
You can also use this setting to switch the
audio channel on DVD-RW discs recorded
with two separate soundtracks.
• Front 0.3 m ~ Front 9 m – Distance can
be set in increments of 0.3 m. The default
is 3 m.
• L-Ch1 R-Ch2 – Both channels are played
through the front speakers
Center speaker distance setting
Specifies the distance from your listening
position to the center speaker:
• Ch1 Mono – Only channel 1 is played
• Ch2 Mono – Only channel 2 is played
• Center 0.3 m ~ Center 9 m – Distance
can be set in increments of 0.3 m. The
default is 3 m.
• On the Ch1 Mono and Ch2 Mono
settings the sound comes only from the
center speaker (or from the front speakers
if listening in STEREO mode).
Surround speakers distance setting
Specifies the distance from your listening
position to the surround speakers:
• This setting works only with dual mono
encoded Dolby Digital or DTS
soundtracks. See the disc packaging for
channel information.
• Surr. 0.3 m ~ Surr. 9 m – Distance can
be set in increments 0.3 m. The default is
3 m.
Dynamic Range Control
Specifies the amount of dynamic range
adjustment to Dolby Digital or DTS
soundtracks:
LFE attenuator setting
Dolby Digital and DTS audio sources include
ultra-low bass tones. Set the LFE attenuator
as needed to prevent the ultra-low bass from
distorting the sound.
• DRC Off – No dynamic range adjustment
(use when listening at higher volume)
• LFE ATT 0 – The LFE channel is played
with no attenuation
• DRC Mid – Mid setting
• DRC High – Dynamic range is reduced
(loud sounds are reduced in volume while
quieter sounds are increased)
• LFE ATT 10 – LFE channel is attenuated
by 10dB
• LFE Off – LFE channel is not played
• This setting works only with Dolby Digital
and some DTS soundtracks. For other
sources you can create a similar effect
using the Midnight mode (see Using
Quiet and Midnight listening modes on
page 34).
58
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Surround sound setup
08
2
Switch the remote control to SUB,
Setting the channel levels
then press TEST TONE to hear the test
tone.
The test tone is output in the following order
(from the speakers active in the current
listening mode):
You can set the relative channel levels from
your main listening position for each listening
mode, including all the Surround and
Advanced Surround modes.
If you used the Room Setup feature (page 20),
the channel levels for each listening mode
will already be set. However, you can still fine-
tune the levels here if you need to.
• L – Front left speaker
• C – Center speaker
• R – Front right speaker
• RS – Right surround speaker
• LS – Left surround speaker
• SW – Subwoofer
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
3
Use the MASTER VOLUME +/– button
to adjust the volume to an appropriate
level.
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
DVD MENU
RETURN
buttons to adjust the speaker levels in
turn.
ENTER
You should hear the test tone at the same
volume from each speaker when seated in the
main listening position. The channel level
range is 10 dB.
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
5
When you’re done, press ENTER to exit
CH
INPUT
VOL
test tone setup.
BASS MODE DALG
VRAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
• The speaker volume can be adjusted
while listening to any sound source you
want by pressing CH LEVEL and then
using the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down) buttons
to adjust the channel levels. After you’re
finished with one channel, use the ꢂ/ꢃ
(cursor left/right) buttons to move to the
next.
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
1
Press SURROUND or ADVANCED
repeatedly to select a listening mode.
• Since the subwoofer produces ultra-low
frequencies its sound may seem quieter
than it actually is.
59
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
09
Video Adjust menu
Chapter 9
Video Adjust menu
Creating your own presets
You can create up to two presets of your own.
Video Adjust
• Default setting: Standard
From the Video Adjust screen you can select
the standard video presentation or define
presets of your own.
1
Select one of the Memory presets (see
above).
2
Press ꢁ (cursor down) to select
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Video
‘Detailed Settings’ then press ENTER.
Adjust’ from the on-screen display.
Video Adjust
Memory1
HOME MENU
DVD
Detailed Settings
Play Mode
Video Adjust
3
Adjust the picture quality settings.
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
Memory1
Recall Settings
Contrast
Memory1
min
min
min
max
max
max
Brightness
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
Chroma Level
buttons to select a preset.
Video Adjust
Standard
• Use the ꢀ/ꢁ(cursor up/down) buttons to
select a setting.
• Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right) buttons
• Standard – Normal
to adjust the current setting.
• Memory1–2 – Use for saving your own
presets (see below)
• Press DISPLAY to switch between full and
single view.
3
Press ENTER to make the setting and
• You can change the preset number from
the Recall Settings menu item.
exit the Video Adjust screen.
• Depending on the disc and the TV/
monitor, you may not see the effect
clearly.
60
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Video Adjust menu
09
You can adjust any or all of the following
picture quality settings:
• Contrast – Adjusts the contrast between
light and dark.
• Brightness – Adjusts the overall bright-
ness.
• Chroma Level – Adjusts how saturated
colors appear.
4
Press ENTER to save the preset and
exit the Video Adjust screen.
61
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Initial Settings menu
Chapter 10
Initial Settings menu
Using the Initial Settings
menu
Digital Audio Mode Settings
Make these settings if you connect an
external digital component to the optical
digital output. Note that DVD-Audio and
SACD audio is not output through this jack.
The Initial Settings menu gives you complete
control in setting up your DVD system,
including video output settings and parental
lock settings, among others.
Dolby Digital Out
If an option is grayed out it means that it
cannot be changed at the current time. This is
usually because a disc is playing. Stop the
disc, then change the setting.
• Default setting: Dolby Digital
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
Dolby Digital
1
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Initial
Dolby Digital > PCM
Settings’ from the on-screen display.
Linear PCM Out
Display
Options
HOME MENU
DVD
Play Mode
Video Adjust
If the connected component is Dolby Digital
compatible, set to Dolby Digital, otherwise
set to Dolby Digital > PCM. Check the
manual that came with the other component
if you’re unsure whether it is Dolby Digital
compatible.
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
2
Select the setup category from the list
on the left, then select an item from the
menu list to the right.
DTS Out
• Default setting: DTS
3
Make the setting you want.
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
DTS
DTS > PCM
Linear PCM Out
• The language options shown in the on-
screen display illustrations on the
Display
Options
following pages may not correspond to
those available in your country or region.
If the connected component has a built-in
DTS decoder, set this to DTS, otherwise set to
DTS > PCM. Check the manual that came
with the other component if you’re unsure
whether it is DTS compatible.
62
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initial Settings menu
10
Video Output settings
• If you set to DTS with non-DTS compatible
equipment, noise will be output when you
play a DTS disc.
TV Screen
• Default setting: 16:9 (Wide)
• DTS-CDs are always output as DTS digital
audio regardless of this setting.
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
4:3 (Letter Box)
4:3 (Pan&Scan)
16:9 (Wide)
TV Screen
Component Out
S-Video Out
Linear PCM Out
• Default setting: Down Sample Off
Display
Options
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
Down Sample On
Down Sample Off
If you have a widescreen TV, select the 16:9
(Wide) setting—widescreen DVD software is
then shown using the full screen area. When
playing software recorded in conventional
(4:3) format, the settings on your TV will
determine how the material is presented—
see the manual that came with your TV for
details on what options are available.
Linear PCM Out
Display
Options
If the connected component is compatible
with high sampling rates (96 kHz), set this to
Down Sample Off, otherwise set it to Down
Sample On (96 kHz audio is converted to a
more compatible 48 kHz). Check the manual
that came with the other component if you’re
unsure whether it is 96 kHz compatible.
If you have a conventional TV, select either 4:3
(Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan). In Letter
Box mode, widescreen software is shown with
black bars at the top and bottom of the
screen. Pan & Scan chops the sides off
widescreen material to make it fit the 4:3
screen (so even though the image looks
larger on the screen, you’re actually seeing
less of the picture). See also Screen sizes and
disc formats on page 87.
• Even when set to Down Sample Off,
some discs will still output down-sampled
audio through the digital outputs (you
only get full sampling rate audio through
the analog outputs).
63
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Initial Settings menu
• If you connect a TV that is not compatible
with a progressive scan signal and switch
the system to progressive, you will not be
able to see any picture at all. In this case,
press ꢂ STANDBY/ON to put the system
in standby, then press and hold the front
panel ꢀ(stop) button for about 8 seconds
until the display shows Mem.Clr.?. Press
the front panel VOL – or + button so that
the display shows Interlace?. Press the
front panel ꢁ button to set to interlace
and switch the system back on.
Component Out
You only need to make this setting if you
connected this system to your TV using the
component video outputs.
• Default setting: Interlace
Initial Settings
Video Output
Language
Display
Interlace
TV Screen
Progressive
Component Out
S-Video Out
Options
Compatibility of this system with
progressive-scan TVs.
This system is compatible with progressive
If you have a progressive-scan compatible TV,
set this to Progressive for flicker-free video
output. If your TV is not compatible with
progressive-scan video, set to Interlace.
Check the operating instructions that came
with your TV if you’re unsure about its
compatibility.
video Macro Vision System Copy Guard.
CONSUMERS SHOULD NOTE THAT NOT ALL HIGH
DEFINITION TELEVISION SETS ARE FULLY
COMPATIBLE WITH THIS PRODUCT AND MAY
CAUSE ARTIFACTS TO BE DISPLAYED IN THE
PICTURE. IN CASE OF 525 PROGRESSIVE SCAN
PICTURE PROBLEMS, IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT
THE USER SWITCH THE CONNECTION TO THE
“STANDARD DEFINITION” OUTPUT. IF THERE ARE
QUESTIONS REGARDING OUR TV SET
When setting to Progressive, you have to
press ENTER once more to confirm (or
RETURN to cancel). See also below for
important information on progressive scan
video.
COMPATIBILITY WITH THIS MODEL 525p DVD
PLAYER, PLEASE CONTACT OUR CUSTOMER
SERVICE CENTER.
About progressive scan video
Compared to interlace video, progressive
scan video effectively doubles the scanning
rate of the picture, resulting in a very stable,
flicker-free image. Progressive scan video is
available only from the component video
output.
This system is compatible with the following
Pioneer displays and monitors: PDP-503HDG,
PDP-433HDG progressive scan-compatible
TVs.
• When Component Out (above) is set to
Progressive, there is no video output
from the VIDEO and S-VIDEO jacks. If you
want to display video on more than one
monitor simultaneously, make sure that it
is set to Interlace.
64
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initial Settings menu
10
S-Video Out
You only need to make this setting if you
connected this system to your TV using an
S-video cable.
• You can switch between the languages
recorded on a DVD-Video disc during
playback using the AUDIO button. (This
does not affect this setting.) See
Switching DVD-Video audio language on
page 47.
• Default setting: S2
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
TV Screen
S1
S2
• Some DVD-Video discs set the audio
language automatically when loaded,
overriding the Audio Language setting.
Component Out
S-Video Out
Display
Options
• Discs with two or more audio languages
usually allow you to select the audio
language from the disc menu. Press DVD
MENU to access the disc menu.
• If you find that the picture is stretched or
distorted on the default S2 setting, try
changing it to S1.
Subtitle Language
• Default setting: English
Language settings
Initial Settings
Audio Language
• Default setting: English
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
English
French
Spanish
Display
Chinese
Initial Settings
Options
Other Language
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
English
French
Spanish
Display
Chinese
This setting is your preferred subtitle
language for DVD-Video discs. If the language
you specify here is recorded on a disc, the
system automatically plays the disc with
those subtitles.
Options
Other Language
This setting is your preferred audio language
for DVD-Video discs. If the language you
specify here is recorded on a disc, the system
automatically plays the disc in that language.
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136
different languages. Select Other Language
if you want to specify a language other than
those listed. See also Selecting languages
using the language code list on page 87.
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136
different languages. Select Other Language
if you want to specify a language other than
those listed. See also Selecting languages
using the language code list on page 87.
65
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Initial Settings menu
Subtitle Display
• Default setting: On
• You can usually change or switch off the
subtitles on a DVD-Video disc during
playback using the SUBTITLE button.
(This does not affect this setting.) See
Switching subtitles on page 47.
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
On
Off
Display
Options
• Some DVD-Video discs set the subtitle
language automatically when loaded,
overriding the Subtitle Language
setting.
When set to On, the player displays subtitles
according to the Subtitle Language setting.
Set to Off to switch subtitles off altogether.
• Discs with two or more subtitle
languages usually allow you to select the
subtitle language from the disc menu.
Press DVD MENU to access the disc
menu.
Display settings
OSD Language
• Default setting: English
DVD Menu Language
• Default setting: w/Subtitle Lang.
Initial Settings
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
English
fran ais
Español
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
w/Subtitle Lang.
English
French
Display
Display
Spanish
Options
Options
Chinese
Other Language
This sets the language of this system’s on-
screen displays.
Some multilingual discs have disc menus in
several languages. This setting specifies in
which language the disc menus should
appear. Leave on the default setting for
menus to appear in the same language as
your Subtitle Language —see above.
On Screen Display
• Default setting: On
Initial Settings
The DVD-Video format recognizes 136
different languages. Select Other Language
if you want to specify a language other than
those listed. See also Selecting languages
using the language code list on page 87.
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
On
Off
Display
Options
66
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initial Settings menu
10
This sets whether operation displays are
shown on-screen (Play, Resume, Scan and so
on).
• Not all discs that you may consider
inappropriate for your children use the
Parental Lock feature. These discs will
always play without requiring the
password first.
Angle Indicator
• Default setting: On
Initial Settings
• If you forget your password, you’ll need to
reset the system to its factory settings
(see Resetting the system on page 77),
then register a new password.
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
On
Off
Display
Options
Registering a new password
You must register a password before you can
change the Parental Lock level or enter a
Country code.
If you prefer not to see the camera icon on-
screen during multi-angle scenes on DVD
discs, change this setting to Off.
1
Select ‘Password’.
Initial Settings
Options
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password
Bonus Group
Level Change
Country Code
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Parental Lock
• Default level: Off
Display
Options
• Default password: none
• Default Country code: us (2119)
2
Use the number buttons to enter a 4-
Some DVD-Video discs feature a Parental
Lock level. If the player is set to a lower level
than the disc, the disc won’t play. This gives
you some control about what your children
watch on your DVD system.
digit password.
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock: Register Code Number
Some discs also support the Country code
feature. The player does not play certain
scenes on these discs, depending on the
Country code you set.
*
*
*
*
Display
Options
Before you can set the Parental Lock level or
the Country code you must register a
password. As the password owner, you can
change the Parental Lock level or Country
code whenever you like. You can also change
the password.
The numbers you enter show up as asterisks
(*) on-screen.
67
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Initial Settings menu
3
Press ENTER to register the password
4
Press ENTER to register the new
and return to the Options menu screen.
If you forget your password, you can reset the
system then register a new one. See Resetting
the system on page 77 for how to reset the
system.
password and return to the Options menu
screen.
Setting/changing the Parental Lock level
1
Select ‘Level Change’.
Changing your password
Initial Settings
To change your password, confirm your
existing password then enter a new one.
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
1
Select ‘Password Change’.
Display
Options
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
Bonus Group
2
Use number buttons to enter your
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
password, then press ENTER.
Display
Options
Initial Settings
Parental Lock : Level Change
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
2
Use the number buttons to enter your
existing password, then press ENTER.
The numbers appear as asterisks as you enter
them.
Options
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off
Initial Settings
3
Select a new level.
Parental Lock: Password Change
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Password
Initial Settings
*
*
*
*
Language
Display
Parental Lock : Level Change
Password
New Password
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Options
*
*
*
*
Display
Options
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off
3
Enter a new password.
Initial Settings
Press ꢂ (cursor left) repeatedly to lock more
levels (more discs will require the password);
press ꢃ (cursor right) to unlock levels. You
can’t lock level 1.
Parental Lock: Password Change
Password
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Display
New Password
Options
4
Press ENTER to set the new level and
return to the Options menu screen.
68
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initial Settings menu
10
• Select by code number: Press ꢃ(cursor
right) then use the number buttons to
enter the 4-digit Country code (you can
find the Country code list on page 88.)
Setting/changing the Country code
You may also want to refer to the Country code
list on page 88.
1
Select ‘Country Code’.
Initial Settings
Initial Settings
Parental Lock: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
Country Code List
us
Code
Display
Options
2
1
1
9
Options
4
Press ENTER to set the new Country
2
Use number buttons to enter your
code and return to the Options menu
screen.
password, then press ENTER.
Initial Settings
Parental Lock Change: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Password
*
*
*
*
• Changing the Country code does not take
effect until the next disc is loaded (or the
current disc is reloaded).
Display
Country Code List
us
Code
Options
2
1
1
9
Bonus Group
3
Select a Country code.
There are two ways you can do this.
Initial Settings
• Select by code letter: Use ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor
ꢄ
Off (us)
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
up/down) to change the Country code.
ꢄ
ꢄ
ꢄ
ꢄ
On
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Single
Display
Initial Settings
DVD-Audio
2ch Area
Options
Parental Lock: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
Country Code List
us
Code
Some DVD-Audio discs have an extra ‘bonus’
group that requires a 4-digit key number to
access. See the disc packaging for details
and the key number.
Options
2
1
1
9
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Bonus Group : Key Number Input
Video Output
Language
_
_
_
_
Display
Options
69
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Initial Settings menu
When you play a DVD-Audio disc that has a
bonus group, the key number input screen
appears automatically. You can also access
the same screen here.
Group Playback
• Default setting: Single
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
All
Single
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
• If you eject the disc, switch the power off,
or unplug the player, you will need to re-
enter the key number.
DVD-Audio discs can have up to 9 groups of
tracks. When set to Single, the selected
group plays and then the disc stops, or
returns to the menu screen. Use the search
function (page 46) to select the group to play.
(You cannot use the track skip ꢌ / ꢍ or
scan buttons ꢌ / ꢍ in this mode.)
Auto Disc Menu
• Default setting: On
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
On
Off
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Set to All if you want to play all the groups on
a disc consecutively.
Display
Options
This specifies whether the menu (Top menu)
is automatically displayed after loading a
disc. Set to On if you want the menu displayed
automatically, or Off if you don’t want it
displayed.
• Even if the player is set to All but you
select a group to play from the disc menu,
only that group will play. If you stop
playback, all groups will play again when
you restart playback.
DVD Playback Mode
• Some DVD discs display a menu
automatically regardless of this setting. If
you press ꢄ while a disc is loading, this
setting is ignored.
• Default setting: DVD-Audio
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
DVD-Audio
DVD-Video
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
Some DVD-Audio discs contain DVD-Video
content in addition to the DVD-Audio. Set to
DVD-Video to play a DVD-Audio disc as if it
were a DVD-Video disc. Note that in this case
only the DVD-Video part of the disc will play.
70
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initial Settings menu
10
PhotoViewer
•
Default setting: On
• This setting reverts to DVD-Audio when
the function is changed, the disc tray is
opened, or the power is switched into
standby.
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
On
Off
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
SACD Playback
• Default setting: Multi-ch Area
Initial Settings
This setting is important if you load a disc that
contains both MP3 audio files and JPEG
picture files.
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
2ch Area
Multi-ch Area
CD Area
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
The default On setting allows you to view only
the JPEG files on this kind of disc. Set to Off
to be able to play the MP3 audio files.
Display
Options
SACD discs can be divided up into several
different areas — stereo audio (2ch Area),
multi-channel audio (Multi-ch Area) and, for
hybrid SACDs, standard CD audio (CD Area).
Select which you want to listen to.
• Changing the PhotoViewer setting does
not take effect until the next disc is loaded
(or the current disc is reloaded).
• If you select an area that isn’t on the disc
loaded, a different area will play. For
example, if you choose standard CD audio
but the disc loaded is not a hybrid SACD,
the stereo SACD area will play.
71
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
Other connections
Chapter 12
Other connections
Connecting external antennas Connecting auxiliary
components
External AM antenna
This system has both stereo analog inputs
and outputs, as well as one optical digital
inputs and one optical digital output. Use
these to connect external components, such
as your VCR, MD or CD-R recorder.
Use 5–6 meters of vinyl-insulated wire and set
up either indoors or outdoors. Leave the AM
loop antenna connected.
Outdoor antenna
•
Connect the TV (IN) jacks to the audio
outs of your TV (or VCR).
This will enable you to hear the TV (or VCR)
through this system. Connect using RCA pin-
plug stereo cables. See also Reducing the TV
and line signal levels on page 73.
Indoor
antenna
(vinyl-coated
wire)
ENNA
5–6 m
BAL AM LOOP
ANTENNA
External FM antenna
Use a 75Ω coaxial cable to hook up an
external FM antenna.
AUDIO
OUTPUT
75Ω coaxial cable
LINE1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
AUDIO
ATENNA
LINE1
OUT
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
XV–DV900/XV–DV700
FM UNBAL AM LOOP
75
ANTENNA
72
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Other connections
11
•
Connect the LINE 1 (IN) jacks to the
•
Connect the LINE 1 (OPTICAL IN) jack
analog outputs of an external playback
component.
These include components such as a VCR or
cassette deck. Connect using RCA pin-plug
stereo cables. See also Reducing the TV and
line signal levels below.
on the rear panel to the optical digital
output of an external playback
component.
OPT
ICAL
DIGIT
AL
IN
LINE
1
•
Connect the LINE 1 (OUT) jacks to the
analog inputs of an external recording
component.
These include components such as a
cassette deck, VCR, MD or another recorder
with analog inputs. Connect using RCA pin-
plug stereo cables.
These include digital components such as an
MD player, digital satellite, or a game system.
Connect using a optical digital cable (not
supplied).
Tape deck, etc.
Reducing the TV and line signal
levels
• Default setting: ATT 6dB
AUDIO
INPUT
AUDIO
OUTPUT
Some sources may produce a high signal
level which may produce unpleasant
distortion from the speakers. In such cases,
you may need to reduce the signal level of the
auxiliary source (connected to the TV or LINE
1 or LINE 2 analog inputs) by switching on the
attenuator.
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
CAL
TAL
N
LINE1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
O
L
L
AUDIO
AUD
R
R
LINE1
OUT
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘TV ATT?’ or ‘LINE1 ATT?’
or ‘LINE2 ATT?’, then press ENTER.
XV–DV900/XV–DV700
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
•
Connect the OPTICAL DIGITAL OUT
buttons to select ‘ATT Off’, ‘ATT 6dB’ or
‘ATT 10dB’.
If the ATT 6dB setting still results in distorted
sound, try the ATT 10dB setting.
jack on the rear panel to the optical digital
input of an external recording
component.
5
Press ENTER to confirm.
OPTICAL
DIGIT
AL
OUT
73
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
Other connections
Recording mode
Connecting using the S-video
output
If your TV has an S-video input, you can use
this instead of the standard video output for a
better quality picture.
The Recording mode allows you to make
analog recordings from the LINE 1 (OUT)
jacks.
When Recording mode is on, most sound-
related functions (including SURROUND,
ADVANCED, AUTO, SYSTEM SETUP)
become inactive. The display will briefly blink
RecMode On if you try and use a prohibited
function while Recording mode is on.
•
Use an S-video cable (not supplied) to
connect the S-VIDEO OUT to an S-video
input on your TV.
Line up the small triangle above the jack with
the same mark on the plug before plugging
in.
When Recording mode is off, the audio from
the analog output may be interrupted,
depending on the operation.
1
Press SOUND.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
S-VIDEO
INPUT
buttons to select ‘Rec Mode?’.
3
Press ENTER.
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
TV
buttons to select ‘R.Mode On’ or ‘R.Mode
Off’.
• When Recording Mode is On a stereo
downmix of multi-channel DVD-Audio
and SACD discs is output from the
speakers and from the analog audio
jacks. Note that with some DVD-Audio
disc, only the front left/right channels are
output. When set to Off, multi-channel
DVD-Audio and SACD discs are played
through all the speakers, but front L/R
audio is output from the analog audio
jack.
ANTENNA
E1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
AM
ANTE
L
L
AUDIO
PR
PB
Y
R
NE1
UT
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
XV–DV900/XV–DV700
• The S-video ouptut is switchable between
S1 and S2 formats for compatibility with
all TVs. See S-Video Out on page 65 for
more on this.
• When R.Mode On is selected while
playing SACD, the unit will loose speaker
SW output and bass will become
inaudible.
74
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Other connections
11
Connecting using the
component video output
If your TV has component video inputs, you
can use these instead of the standard video
output to connect this system to your TV. This
should give you the best quality picture from
the three types of video output available.
•
Use a component video cable (not
supplied) to connect the COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT to a set of component inputs
on your TV.
COMPONENT
INPUT
ANTENNA
FM BAL LOOP
TENNA
AUDIO
E1
LINE2
IN
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
N
XV–DV900/XV–DV700
• The component video ouptut is
switchable between interlaced and
progressive formats. See Component Out
on page 64 for more on this.
75
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Chapter 12
Additional information
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
Switching off the demo
buttons to select ‘Lock On?’ or ‘Lock Off?’.
• Default setting: Demo On
5
Press ENTER to confirm.
This system has an automatic demo feature
that starts when the system is plugged in for
the first time.
Changing the clock format
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
• Default setting: 12-Hour
You can choose to display the clock in either
12 or 24 hour formats.
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
buttons to select ‘Demo Mode?’, then
press ENTER.
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘Demo Off?’ then press
ENTER to confirm.
buttons to select ‘12/24 Hour?’, then press
ENTER.
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select either ‘12-Hour?’ or ‘24-
Hour?’.
• After setting the clock, the demo mode
switches off automatically. However, if
you unplug the system from the wall
outlet, the demo mode will revert to Demo
On (and the clock will be reset).
5
Press ENTER to confirm.
Changing the frequency step
• Default setting: FM 100 AM 10
If you find that you can’t tune into stations
successfully, the frequency step may not be
suitable for your country/region.
Child Lock
• Default setting: Lock Off
This system has a child lock feature that
makes the front panel buttons and controls
inoperative.
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘FM AM Step?’, then
press ENTER.
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select ‘Child Lock?’, then press
ENTER.
buttons to select ‘FM 50 AM 9?’ or ‘FM 100
AM 10?’ then press ENTER to confirm.
76
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Setting the TV format
Watching NTSC on a PAL TV
(MOD. PAL)
• Default setting: AUTO
The default setting of this system is AUTO,
and unless you notice that the picture is
distorted when playing some discs, you
should leave it set to AUTO. If you experience
picture distortion with some discs, set the TV
system to match your country or region’s
system. Doing this, however, may restrict the
kinds of disc you can watch. The table below
shows what kinds of disc are compatible with
each setting (AUTO, PAL and NTSC).
Most models of the newly developed count-
down PAL TV system detect 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz
(NTSC) and automatically switch vertical
amplitude, resulting in a display without
vertical shrinkage. However, in some cases,
the image may appear without color.
If your PAL TV does not have a V-Hold control,
you may not be able to watch NTSC discs
because of picture roll. If the TV has a V-Hold
control, adjust it until the picture stops
rolling.
1
2
3
Switch the system into standby.
Press SYSTEM SETUP.
On some TVs, the picture may shrink verti-
cally, leaving black bands at the top and
bottom of the screen. This is not a malfunc-
tion; it is caused by the NTSC to PAL conver-
sion.
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ (cursor left/right)
buttons to select ‘TV System?’, then press
ENTER.
4
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ (cursor up/down)
buttons to select Auto, PAL or NTSC, then
press ENTER to confirm.
Resetting the system
Use this procedure to reset all system
settings (except for station memory) to the
factory default.
Disc
Type
DVD
Player setting
Format NTSC PAL
NTSC NTSC
PAL NTSC
Video CD NTSC NTSC
1
Switch the system into standby.
AUTO
ꢀ
2
Press and hold the top panel (Stop)
MOD.PAL NTSC
button for about 8 seconds until the
display shows ‘Mem.Clr.?’.
PAL
PAL
MOD.PAL NTSC
3
Press the top panel ꢁ button.
The system’s settings are now reset, and you
should see the ‘Welcome to Pioneer DVD !’
screen.
PAL
—
NTSC
NTSC
PAL
PAL
PAL
CD/no disc
NTSC or
PAL
Dimming the display
• Default setting: 3
The display has three brightness levels (1–3).
1
Press DIMMER to change the
brightness level of the display unit.
77
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
mark, which you can find on the rear panel.
Discs from incompatible regions will not play
in this player. Discs marked ALL will play in
any player.
Using and taking care of discs
Titles, groups, chapters and tracks
DVD discs are generally divided into one or
more titles. Titles may be further subdivided
into chapters.
The diagram below shows the various DVD
regions of the world.
Title 1
Title 2
Title 3
Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 Chapter 1 Chapter 1 Chapter 2
DVD-Audio discs are divided into one or more
groups that can each contain a number of
tracks.
Group 1
Track 1
Group 2 Group 3
Track 2
Track 3
Track 1
Track 1
Track 2
CDs, SACDs and Video CD/Super VCDs are
divided into tracks.
Track 1 Track 2 Track 3 Track 4 Track 5 Track 6
CD-ROMs contain folders and files. MP3 files
are referred to as tracks. Folders may contain
further folders.
Folder A
Track 1
Folder B Folder C
Track 2
Track 3
Track 1
File 1
File 2
DVD Video regions
All DVD Video discs carry a region mark on
the case somewhere that indicates which
region(s) of the world the disc is compatible
with. Your DVD system also has a region
78
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Handling discs
Storing discs
When holding discs of any type, take care not
to leave fingerprints, dirt or scratches on the
disc surface. Hold the disc by its edge or by
the center hole and edge.
Although CDs and DVD discs are more
durable than vinyl records, you should still
take care to handle and store discs correctly.
When you're not using a disc, return it to its
case and store upright. Avoid leaving discs in
excessively cold, humid, or hot environments
(including under direct sunlight).
Damaged or dirty discs can affect playback
performance. Take care also not to scratch
the label side of the disc. Although not as
fragile as the recorded side, scratches can
still result in a disc becoming unusable.
Don't glue paper or put stickers onto the disc,
or use a pencil, ball-point pen or other sharp-
tipped writing instrument. These could all
damage the disc.
Should a disc become marked with
fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft, dry
cloth, wiping the disc lightly from the center
to the outside edge as shown in the diagram
below.
For more detailed care information see the
instructions that come with discs.
Do not load more than one disc into the player
at a time.
Wipe lightly from the center of the disc using
straight strokes.
Discs to avoid
Discs spin at high speed inside the player. If
you can see that a disc is cracked, chipped,
warped, or otherwise damaged, don't risk
using it in your player—you could end up
damaging the unit.
Don’t wipe the disc surface using circular
strokes.
If necessary, use a cloth soaked in alcohol, or
a commercially available CD/DVD cleaning kit
to clean a disc more thoroughly. Never use
benzine, thinner or other cleaning agents,
including products designed for cleaning
vinyl records.
This unit is designed for use with
conventional, fully circular discs only. Use of
shaped discs is not recommended for this
product. Pioneer disclaims all liability arising
in connection with the use of shaped discs.
79
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Cleaning the pickup lens
Proper installation and
The DVD player’s lens should not become
dirty in normal use, but if for some reason it
should malfunction due to dust or dirt,
consult your nearest Pioneer authorized
service center. Although lens cleaners are
commercially available, we do not
recommend using them since some may
damage the lens.
maintenance of this system
Hints on installation
We want you to enjoy using this system for
years to come, so please bear in mind the
following points when choosing a suitable
location for it:
Do...
Problems with condensation
Condensation may form inside the player if it
is brought into a warm room from outside, or
if the temperature of the room rises quickly.
Although the condensation won’t damage the
player, it may temporarily impair its
performance. For this reason you should
leave it to adjust to the warmer temperature
for about an hour before switching on and
using.
ꢄUse in a well-ventilated room.
ꢄPlace on a solid, flat, level surface, such
as a table, shelf or stereo rack.
Don’t...
ꢅ Use in a place exposed to high
temperatures or humidity, including near
radiators and other heat-generating
appliances.
ꢅ Place on a window sill or other place
where the system will be exposed to direct
sunlight.
Moving the system unit
ꢅ Use in an excessively dusty or damp
environment.
If you need to move the main unit, first remove
a disc if there’s one in the player, then press
ꢂ STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn
the system off. Wait for Good Bye to
disappear from the display, then unplug the
power cable. Never lift or move the unit during
playback—discs rotate at a high speed and
may be damaged.
ꢅ Place directly on top of an amplifier, or
other component in your stereo system
that becomes hot in use.
ꢅ Use near a television or monitor as you
may experience interference—especially
if the television uses an indoor antenna.
ꢅ Use in a kitchen or other room where the
system may be exposed to smoke or
steam.
• Unplugging the unit before Good Bye
disappears from the display may cause
the system to return to the factory
settings.
ꢅ Use on a thick rug or carpet, or cover with
cloth—this may prevent proper cooling of
the system.
ꢅ Place on an unstable surface, or one that
is not large enough to support all four of
the unit’s feet.
80
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Power cord caution
Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not
pull out the plug by tugging the cord and
never touch the power cord when your hands
are wet as this could cause a short circuit or
an electric shock. Do not place this unit, a
piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or
pinch the cord. Never make a knot in the cord
or tie it with other cords. The power cords
should be routed such that they are not likely
to be stepped on. A damaged power cord can
cause a fire or give you an electrical shock.
Check the power cord once in a while. When
you find it damaged, ask your nearest Pioneer
authorized service center or your dealer for a
replacement.
81
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Troubleshooting
Incorrect operations are often mistaken for trouble and malfunctions. If you think that there is
something wrong with this component, check the points below. Sometimes the trouble may lie
in another component. Investigate the other components and electrical appliances being used.
If the trouble cannot be rectified even after exercising the checks listed below, ask your nearest
Pioneer authorized service center or your dealer to carry out repair work.
• If the system does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity
disconnect the power plug from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating
conditions.
General
Problem
Remedy
The power does not
turn on.
• Connect the power plug to the wall outlet.
• Disconnect the power plug from the outlet, and insert again.
• Make sure there are no loose strands of speaker wire touching the rear
panel. This could cause the system to shut off automatically.
No sound is output
when a function is
selected.
• If you’re using the line input, make sure the component is connected
correctly (see Connecting auxiliary components on page 72).
• Press MUTE on the remote control to turn muting off.
• Adjust the VOLUME.
No image is output
when playing discs.
• Make sure the TV is connected correctly (refer to the Setup Guide).
• Reset the video output to interlace (see Component Out on page 64)
No sound from
surround or center
speakers.
• Refer to Setting the channel levels on page 59 to check the speaker levels.
• Check that you haven’t selected the STEREO sound mode (see Listening
in surround sound on page 30).
• Check that the Virtual mode is not on (Using the Advanced Surround
effects on page 32).
• Connect the speakers properly (refer to the Setup Guide).
Can’t operate the
remote control.
• Replace the batteries (refer to the Setup Guide).
• Operate within 23 ft. (7 m), 30° of the remote sensor on the display unit
(refer to the Setup Guide).
• Remove any obstacles or operate from another position.
• Avoid exposing the remote sensor on the display unit to direct light.
No display
• Make sure everything is connected properly.
82
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Problem
Remedy
Timer indicator is
blinking and the
• Unplug the unit, then plug back in. Wait for one minute then switch on.
• Make sure the fan at the AMP section of the unit is not being blocked.
system will not switch • Check that the speakers are connected correctly.
on.
• If the problem persists, take it to your nearest Pioneer
authorized service center or your dealer for servicing.
DVD/CD/Video CD player
Problem
Remedy
The disc is ejected
automatically after
loading.
• Clean the disc.
• Align the disc properly in the disc guide.
• If the region number on a DVD-video disc does not match the number on
the player, the disc cannot be used (see DVD Video regions on page 78).
• Allow time for any condensation inside the player to evaporate. Avoid
using the player near an air-conditioning unit.
Playback is not
possible.
• If the disc is loaded upside down, reload the disc with the label side face
up.
Picture playback stops
and the operation
buttons cannot be
used.
• Press ꢀ (stop), then ꢄ (play) to start playback again.
• Switch the power off once, then on again using the front panel
ꢂ STANDBY/ON button.
Settings are canceled. • When the power is cut due to power failure or by unplugging the power
cable, settings will be canceled.
No picture/No color.
• Check that connections are correct and that plugs are inserted fully.
• Check the instruction manual of the TV/monitor to make sure the TV/
monitor settings are incorrect.
• If your TV/monitor is connected using an S-video cable, try changing the
S-Video Out setting (see S-Video Out on page 65).
Screen is stretched or
aspect does not
change.
• The TV Screen setting is incorrect. Set the TV Screen option to match the
TV/monitor you're using (see TV Screen on page 63).
When recorded on a
• This system uses copy-protection technology which may prevent
VCR or passed through recording or cause picture problems when connected through a VCR or AV
an AV selector, there is selector. This is not a malfunction.
disturbance in the
playback picture.
83
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Problem
Remedy
Picture disturbance
during playback or
dark.
• This player is compatible with Macro-Vision System copy guard. Some
discs include a copy prevention signal, and when this type of disc is played
back, stripes etc., may appear on some sections of the picture depending
on the TV. This is not a malfunction.
• Discs respond differently to particular player functions. This may result in
the screen becoming black for a brief instant or shaking slightly when the
function is executed. These problems are largely due to differences
between discs and disc content and are not malfunctions of this player.
Noticeable difference
in DVD and CD
volume.
• DVDs and CDs use different recording methods. This is not a
malfunction.
Incompletesoundfrom
headphones when
listening to a DVD-
Audio disc.
• Some multichannel DVD-Audio discs only output the front/right
channels through headphones.
MP3/JPEG discs
Problem
Remedy
CD-ROM disc is not
recognized by the
system.
• Make sure that the CD-ROM was recorded using the ISO 9660 disc
format. See General disc compatibility on page 9 for other disc compatibility
information.
Files don’t show up in • The files on the disc must be named with the correct file extention: .mp3
the Disc Navigator/
Photo Browser.
for MP3 files; .jpg for JPEG files (upper or lower-case is OK). See General
disc compatibility on page 9 for other disc compatibility information.
JPEG files appear, but • Set the PhotoViewer menu option in the Initial Settings menu to Off to
MP3 files don’t show
up.
be able to access the MP3 files. See PhotoViewer on page 71.
84
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Tuner
Problem
Considerable noise in • Connect the antenna (refer to the Setup Guide).
radio broadcasts. • Fully extend the FM wire antenna, position for best reception, and secure
Remedy
to a wall.
• Connect an outdoor FM antenna (see Connecting external antennas on
page 72).
• Adjust the direction and position for best reception.
• Connect an additional internal or external AM antenna (refer to the Setup
Guide and Connecting external antennas on page 72).
• Turn off any other equipment that may be causing the noise or move it
away from the main unit.
• The tuning interval is incorrect for your country or region. Try switching
the tuning interval (frequency step) (see Changing the frequency step on
page 76).
Auto tuning does not • The radio signal is weak. Auto tuning will only detect radio stations with a
pick up some stations. good signal. For more sensitive tuning, connect an outdoor antenna.
Sound is mono only.
• Check that the tuner is not set to FM mono (see Improving poor FM
reception on page 28).
Error Messages
Message
Desciption
Child Lock
• This message appears when the front panel buttons are pressed when
the child lock feature is active. See Child Lock on page 76 for more on
switching on/off the child lock.
Rec Mode On
Phones In
96K Stereo
No Surr. SP
Muting
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the
Recording Mode is on (see Recording mode on page 74).
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because
headphones are connected.
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the
source is digital 88.2 or 96kHz PCM.
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because
there is no surround speaker output.
• Blinks rapidly for 2 seconds when an operation is prohibited because the
sound is muted (see Muting the sound on page 36).
Exit
• Appears briefly when a menu is automatically exited after a set period of
inactivity.
85
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Message
Desciption
DVD-AUDIO
• Blinks rapidly when one of the below buttons is pressed while a DVD-
Audio disc is loaded.
·AUTO ·SURROUND ·ADVANCED ·DIALOGUE ·VIRTUAL SB
·BASS MODE
SACD
• Blinks rapidly when one of the below buttons is pressed while a SACD
disc is loaded.
·AUTO ·SURROUND ·ADVANCED ·DIALOGUE ·VIRTUAL SB
·BASS MODE
86
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
options; see the
instructions that
came with your TV for widescreen discs are
Set to 4:3
(Pan&Scan),
Screen sizes
and disc
Selecting
languages
using the
language
details.
shown with the left
and right sides
cropped. Although
the picture looks
larger, you don’t
actually see the whole options (see
picture.
formats
DVD-Video discs
come in several
Please note that
some movie aspect
ratios are wider than
16:9, so even though
you have a
widescreen TV, these
discs will still play in a
‘letterbox’ style with
black bars at the top
and bottom of the
screen.
code list
different screen
Some of the language
aspects, rangingfrom
TV programs, which
are generally 4:3, to
CinemaScope
widescreen movies,
with an aspect ratio of
up to about 7:3.
Language settings on
page 65) allow you to
set your prefered
language from any of
the 136 languages
listed in the Language
code list on page 88.
Televisions also come
in different aspect
ratios; ‘standard’ 4:3
and widescreen 16:9.
Please note that
many widescreen
discs override the
system’s settings so
that the disc is shown
in letterbox format
regardless of the
setting.
1
Select ‘Other
Standard TV
users
Language’.
If you have a standard
TV, the TV Screen
setting (page 63) of
this system should be
set to 4:3 (Letter
Box) or 4:3
(Pan&Scan),
depending on which
you prefer.
2
Use the ꢂ/ꢃ
Widescreen TV
users
If you have a
widescreenTV, the TV
Screen setting
(page 63) of this
system should be set
to 16:9 (Wide).
(cursor left/right)
buttons to select
either a code letter
or a code number.
3
Use the ꢀ/ꢁ
(cursor up/down)
buttons to select a
code letter or a code
number.
See the Language
code list on page 88
(next page) for a
complete list of
• Using the 16:9
(Wide) setting
Set to 4:3 (Letter
Box), widescreen
discs are shown with
black bars top and
bottom.
When you watch
discs recorded in 4:3
format, you can use
the TV controls to
select how the picture
is presented. Your TV
may offer various
with a standard
4:3 TV, or either of
the 4:3 settings
with a widescreen
TV, will result in a
distorted picture.
languages and codes.
zoom and stretch
87
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Language code list
Language (Language code letter), Language code
Japanese (ja), 1001
English (en), 0514
French (fr), 0618
German (de), 0405
Italian (it), 0920
Spanish (es), 0519
Dutch (nl), 1412
Russian (ru), 1821
Chinese (zh), 2608
Korean (ko), 1115
Greek (el), 0512
Basque (eu), 0521
Persian (fa), 0601
Finnish (fi), 0609
Fiji (fj), 0610
Faroese (fo), 0615
Frisian (fy), 0625
Lithuanian (lt), 1220
Latvian (lv), 1222
Malagasy (mg), 1307
Maori (mi), 1309
Macedonian (mk), 1311
Malayalam (ml), 1312
Mongolian (mn), 1314
Moldavian (mo), 1315
Marathi (mr), 1318
Malay (ms), 1319
Maltese (mt), 1320
Burmese (my), 1325
Nauru (na), 1401
Samoan (sm), 1913
Shona (sn), 1914
Somali (so), 1915
Albanian (sq), 1917
Serbian (sr), 1918
Siswati (ss), 1919
Sesotho (st), 1920
Sundanese (su), 1921
Swedish (sv), 1922
Swahili (sw), 1923
Tamil (ta), 2001
Telugu (te), 2005
Tajik (tg), 2007
Thai (th), 2008
Tigrinya (ti), 2009
Turkmen (tk), 2011
Tagalog (tl), 2012
Setswana (tn), 2014
Tonga (to), 2015
Turkish (tr), 2018
Irish (ga), 0701
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704
Galician (gl), 0712
Guarani (gn), 0714
Gujarati (gu), 0721
Hausa (ha), 0801
Hindi (hi), 0809
Croatian (hr), 0818
Hungarian (hu), 0821
Armenian (hy), 0825
Interlingua (ia), 0901
Interlingue (ie), 0905
Inupiak (ik), 0911
Indonesian (in), 0914
Icelandic (is), 0919
Hebrew (iw), 0923
Yiddish (ji), 1009
Javanese (jw), 1023
Georgian (ka), 1101
Kazakh (kk), 1111
Greenlandic (kl), 1112
Cambodian (km), 1113
Kannada (kn), 1114
Kashmiri (ks), 1119
Kurdish (ku), 1121
Kirghiz (ky), 1125
Latin (la), 1201
Afar (aa), 0101
Abkhazian (ab), 0102
Afrikaans (af), 0106
Amharic (am), 0113
Arabic (ar), 0118
Assamese (as), 0119
Aymara (ay), 0125
Azerbaijani (az), 0126
Bashkir (ba), 0201
Byelorussian (be), 0205
Bulgarian (bg), 0207
Bihari (bh), 0208
Bislama (bi), 0209
Bengali (bn), 0214
Tibetan (bo), 0215
Breton (br), 0218
Catalan (ca), 0301
Corsican (co), 0315
Czech (cs), 0319
Nepali (ne), 1405
Norwegian (no), 1415
Occitan (oc), 1503
Oromo (om), 1513
Oriya (or), 1518
Panjabi (pa), 1601
Polish (pl), 1612
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Tsonga (ts), 2019
Portuguese (pt), 1620
Quechua (qu), 1721
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),
1813
Kirundi (rn), 1814
Romanian (ro), 1815
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823
Sanskrit (sa), 1901
Sindhi (sd), 1904
Sangho (sg), 1907
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908
Sinhalese (si), 1909
Slovak (sk), 1911
Tatar (tt), 2020
Twi (tw), 2023
Ukrainian (uk), 2111
Urdu (ur), 2118
Uzbek (uz), 2126
Vietnamese (vi), 2209
Volapük (vo), 2215
Wolof (wo), 2315
Xhosa (xh), 2408
Yoruba (yo), 2515
Zulu (zu), 2621
Welsh (cy), 0325
Danish (da), 0401
Bhutani (dz), 0426
Esperanto (eo), 0515
Estonian (et), 0520
Lingala (ln), 1214
Laothian (lo), 1215
Slovenian (sl), 1912
Country code list
Country, Country code, Country code letter
Argentina, 0118, ar
Australia, 0121, au
Austria, 0120, at
Belgium, 0205, be
Brazil, 0218, br
Canada, 0301, ca
Chile, 0312, cl
China, 0314, cn
Denmark, 0411, dk
Finland, 0609, fi
France, 0618, fr
Germany, 0405, de
Hong Kong, 0811, hk
India, 0914, in
Indonesia, 0904, id
Italy, 0920, it
Japan, 1016, jp
Korea, Republic of, 1118,
kr
Mexico, 1324, mx
Spain, 0519, es
Switzerland, 0308, ch
Sweden, 1905, se
Taiwan, 2023, tw
Thailand, 2008, th
United Kingdom, 0702, gb
United States of America,
Netherlands, 1412, nl
New Zealand, 1426, nz
Norway, 1415, no
Pakistan, 1611, pk
Philippines, 1608, ph
Portugal, 1620, pt
Russian Federation, 1821, 2119, us
ru
Singapore, 1907, sg
Malaysia, 1325, my
88
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Preset code list
Please note that there are cases where only certain functions may be controllable after
assigning the proper preset code, or the codes for the manufacturer in the list will not work for
the model that you are using.
MANUFACTURER Code(s)
ACURA 644
ERRES 607
ITC 642
OSUME 648
ADMIRAL 631
AIWA 660
AKAI 632, 635, 642
AKURA 641
FERGUSON 607, 636, 651
FINLANDIA 635, 643, 655
FINLUX 632, 607, 645, 648, JVC 613, 623
ITT 631, 632, 642
JEC 605
OTTO VERSAND 631, 632,
607, 642
PALLADIUM 638
PANAMA 646
653, 654, 655
KAISUI 618, 641, 644
ALBA 607, 639, 641, 644
AMSTRAD 642, 644, 647
ANITECH 644
ASA 645
FIRSTLINE 640, 644
KAPSCH 631
KENDO 642
KENNEDY 632, 642
KORPEL 607
PANASONIC 631, 607,
608,642, 622
PATHO CINEMA 642
PAUSA 644
PHILCO 632, 642
PHILIPS 631, 607, 634, 656
PHOENIX 632
FISHER 632, 635, 638, 645
FORMENTI 632, 607, 642
FRONTECH 631, 642, 646
ASUKA 641
FRONTECH/PROTECH 632 KOYODA 644
AUDIOGONIC 607, 636
BASIC LINE 641, 644
BAUR 631, 607, 642
BEKO 638
FUJITSU 648, 629
FUNAI 640, 646, 658
GBC 632, 642
GE 601, 608, 607, 610, 617, LUXOR 632, 642, 643
602, 628, 618
GEC 607, 634, 648
GELOSO 632, 644
GENEXXA 631, 641
LEYCO 607, 640, 646, 648
LIESENK&TTER 607
LOEWE 607
PHONOLA 607
PROFEX 642, 644
PROTECH 607, 642, 644,
646, 649
QUELLE631, 632, 607, 642,
645, 653
BEON 607
M-ELECTRONIC 631, 644,
645, 654, 655, 656, 607,
636, 651
BLAUPUNKT 631
BLUE SKY 641
BLUE STAR 618
BPL 618
MAGNADYNE 632, 649
GOLDSTAR 610, 623, 621, MAGNAFON 649
R-LINE 607
BRANDT 636
BTC 641
602, 607, 650
GOODMANS 607, 639,
647, 648, 656
GORENJE 638
GPM 641
GRAETZ 631, 642
GRANADA 607, 635, 642,
643, 648
GRADIENTE 630, 657
GRANDIN 618
GRUNDIG 631, 653
HANSEATIC 607, 642
HCM 618, 644
MAGNAVOX 607, 610,
603, 612, 629
MANESTH 639, 646
MARANTZ 607
MARK 607
MATSUI 607, 639, 640,
642, 644, 647, 648
MCMICHAEL 634
MEDIATOR 607
MEMOREX 644
METZ 631
RADIOLA 607
RADIOSHACK 610, 623,
621, 602
BUSH 607, 641, 642, 644,
647, 656
CASCADE 644
CATHAY 607
CENTURION 607
CGB 642
RBM 653
RCA 601, 610, 615, 616,
617, 618, 661, 662, 609
REDIFFUSION 632, 642
REX 631, 646
ROADSTAR 641, 644, 646
SABA 631, 636, 642, 651
SAISHO 639, 644, 646
SALORA 631, 632, 642, 643
CIMLINE 644
CLARIVOX 607
CLATRONIC 638
CONDOR 638
CONTEC 644
MINERVA 631, 653
MITSUBISHI 609, 610, 602, SAMBERS 649
CROSLEY 632
CROWN 638, 644
CRYSTAL 642
CYBERTRON 641
DAEWOO 607, 644, 656
DAINICHI 641
DANSAI 607
DAYTON 644
DECCA 607, 648
DIXI 607, 644
DUMONT 653
ELIN 607
HINARI 607, 641, 644
HISAWA 618
HITACHI 631, 633, 634,
636, 642, 643, 654, 606,
610, 624, 625, 618
HUANYU 656
HYPSON 607, 618, 646
ICE 646, 647
IMPERIAL 638, 642
INDIANA 607
INGELEN 631
INTERFUNK 631, 632, 607, OCEANIC 631, 632, 642
642
INTERVISION 646, 649
ISUKAI 641
621, 631
MULTITECH 644, 649
NEC 659
NECKERMANN 631, 607
NEI 607, 642
NIKKAI 605, 607, 641, 646, SCHAUB LORENZ 642
SAMSUNG 607, 638, 644,
646
SANYO 635, 645, 648, 621,
614
SBR 607, 634
648
SCHNEIDER 607, 641, 647
SEG 642, 646
SEI 632, 640, 649
SELECO 631, 642
SHARP 602, 619, 627
SIAREM 632, 649
SIEMENS 631
NOBLIKO 649
NOKIA 632, 642, 652
NORDMENDE 632, 636,
651, 652
ELITE 641
ELTA 644
EMERSON 642
ORION 632, 607, 639, 640
OSAKI 641, 646, 648
OSO 641
SINUDYNE 632, 639, 640,
649
89
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
SKANTIC 643
SOLAVOX 631
SONOKO 607, 644
SONOLOR 631, 635
SONTEC 607
SONY 604
SOUNDWAVE 607
STANDARD 641, 644
STERN 631
SUSUMU 641
SYSLINE 607
TANDY 631, 641, 648
TASHIKO 634
TATUNG 607, 648
TEC 642
TELEAVIA 636
TELEFUNKEN 636, 637, 652
TELETECH 644
TENSAI 640, 641
THOMSON 636, 651, 652, 663
THORN 631, 607, 642, 645, 648
TOMASHI 618
TOSHIBA 605, 602, 626, 621, 653
TOWADA 642
ULTRAVOX 632, 642, 649
UNIVERSUM 631, 607, 638, 642, 645, 646, 654, 655
VESTEL 607
VICTOR 613
VOXSON 631
WALTHAM 643
WATSON 607
WATT RADIO 632, 642, 649
WHITE
WESTINGHOUSE 607
YOKO 607, 642, 646
ZENITH 603, 620
PIONEER 600, 631, 632, 607, 636, 642, 651
90
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Dolby Digital
Glossary
1
Analog audio
An electrical signal that directly represents
sound. Compare this to digital audio which
can be an electrical signal, but is an indirect
representation of sound. See also Digital
audio.
Using a maximum of 5.1 channels of audio,
this high quality surround system is used in
many of the finer movie theaters around the
world.
The on-screen display shows which channels
are active, for example showing 3/2.1. The 3
being the two front channels and the center
channel; the 2 being the surround channels,
and the .1 being the LFE channel.
Aspect ratio
The width of a TV screen relative to its height.
Conventional TVs are 4:3 (in other words, the
screen is almost square); widescreen models
are 16:9 (the screen is almost twice as wide as
it is high).
Dolby Pro Logic / Pro Logic II
Bonus Group (DVD-Audio only)
An ‘extra’ group on some DVD-Audio discs
that requires a key number to access. See
also Bonus Group on page 69.
A matrix decoding system that extracts 4.1
(Dolby Pro Logic) or 5.1 (Dolby Pro Logic II)
channel surround sound from a two channel
source.
Browsable pictures (DVD-Audio only)
A feature of some DVD-Audio discs in which
the user can browse still pictures recorded on
the disc as the audio is played. See also Slide-
show.
DTS
R
Digital audio
DTS stands for Digital Theater Systems. DTS
is a surround system different from Dolby
Digital that has become a popular surround
sound format for movies.
An indirect representation of sound by
numbers. During recording, the sound is
measured at discrete intervals (44,100 times a
second for CD audio) by an analog-to-digital
converter, generating a stream of numbers.
On playback, a digital-to-analog converter
generates an analog signal based on these
numbers. See also Sampling frequency and
Analog audio.
Dynamic range
The difference between the quietest and
loudest sounds possible in an audio signal
(without distorting or getting lost in noise).
Dolby Digital and DTS soundtracks are
capable of a very wide dynamic range, deliv-
ering dramatic cinema-like effects.
91
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
EXIF (Exchangeable Image File)
A file format developed by Fuji Photo Film for
digital still cameras. Digital cameras from
various manuafcturers use this compressed
file format which carries date, time and
thumbnail information, as well as the picture
data.
MPEG video
The video format used for Video CDs and
DVDs. Video CD uses the older MPEG-1 stan-
dard, while DVD uses the newer and much
better quality MPEG-2 standard.
PBC (PlayBack Control) (Video CD/Super
VCD only)
A system of navigating a Video CD/Super VCD
through on-screen menus recorded onto the
disc. Especially good for discs that you would
normally not watch from beginning to end all
at once—karaoke discs, for example.
File extension
A tag added to the end of a filename to indi-
cate the type of file. For example, “.mp3” indi-
cates an MP3 file.
ISO 9660 format
International standard for the volume and file
structure of CD-ROM discs.
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)
The most common system of encoding digital
audio, found on CDs and DAT. Excellent
quality, but requires a lot of data compared to
formats such as Dolby Digital and MPEG
audio. See also Digital audio.
JPEG
A file format used for still images, such as
photographs and illustrations. JPEG files are
identified by the file extension “.jpg” or “.JPG”.
Most digital cameras use this format.
Regions (DVD-Video only)
These associate discs and players with partic-
ular areas of the world. This system will only
play discs that have compatible region codes.
You can find the region code of your system
by looking on the rear panel. Some discs are
compatible with more than one region (or all
regions).
MP3
MP3 (MPEG1 audio layer 3) is a compressed
audio file format. Files are recognized by their
file extension “.mp3” or “.MP3”.
MLP / Packed PCM (DVD-Audio only)
A lossless compression system that enables
more PCM audio to be stored on a DVD-
Audio disc than would otherwise be possible.
S1 S-video output
This S-video signal format includes aspect
ratio information (4:3 or 16:9) within the video
signal.
MPEG audio
An audio format used on Video CDs and some
DVD discs. This system can convert MPEG
audio to PCM format for wider compatibility
with digital recorders and AV amplifiers. See
also PCM (Pulse Code Modulation).
S2 S-video output
S2 is an enhanced version of S-video which, in
addition to aspect ratio information, contains
letterbox / pan & scan information.
Widescreen TVs which are compatible with
S2 S-video automatically switch to the
appropriate mode according to the signal.
92
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Sampling frequency
The rate at which sound is measured to be
turned into digital audio data. The higher the
rate, the better the sound quality, but the
more digital information is generated. Stan-
dard CD audio has a sampling frequency of
44.1kHz, which means 44,100 samples
(measurements) per second. See also Digital
audio.
Slide show (DVD, Video CD/Super VCD)
A feature of some DVD discs and Video-CD/
Super VCDs in which still pictures recorded
on the disc cycle automatically as the audio is
played. See also Browsable pictures.
Super Audio CD (SACD)
Super Audio CD is a high quality audio disc
format that can accomodate high sampling
rate stereo and multi-channel audio, as well
as conventional CD audio all on the same
disc.
93
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Additional information
Accessories
Specifications
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Setup guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Display unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Remote control unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Video Cord (yellow plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Display cable (gray plugs). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Control cable A (blue plugs). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Control cable B (black plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
FM antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Dry cell batteries (AA/R6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Speaker cords (5 m) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Speaker cords (10 m) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Non-skid pads (center speaker)
(S-DV700ST only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Non-skid pads (subwoofer). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Speaker stands (front/surround speakers) . . . 4
Speaker stand (center speaker)
(S-DV900ST only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Large screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Medium screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Small screw (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Cover plate (S-DV900ST only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Amplifier Section
Continuous Power (RMS) . . . . . 75 W / channel
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (1 kHz, THD 10%, 6 Ω)
Disc section
Digital audio
characteristics . . . . . . . . DVD fs: 96 kHz, 24-bit
Type . . . . . . DVD system, Video CD system and
Compact Disc digital audio system
Frequency response
48 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 22 kHz
96 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 44 kHz
192 kHz sampling . . . . . . . . . 4 Hz – 88 kHz
S/N ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108dB
Dynamic range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95dB
Total harmonic distortion. . . . . . . . . . . . 0.005 %
Wow and Flutter . . . . . . . Limit of measurement
(
0.001 % W.PEAK) or less (JEITA)
FM tuner section
Frequency Range . . . . . . . . . . . . .87.5 - 108MHz
Antenna. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 Ω, unbalanced
Satellite Speaker System
(S-DV700ST)
Type Sealed, antimagnetic
AM tuner section
Frequency Range
Speaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8.7 cm (cone type)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.2 cm (cone type)
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 – 20,000 Hz
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)
Front / Surround speakers
Dimensions . . . . 110 (W) x 59 (D) x 284 (H) cm
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg
Center speaker
. . . . . . . . . . . .531 kHz to 1,602 kHz (9 kHz step)
. . . . . . . . . . .530 kHz to 1,700 kHz (10 kHz step)
Antenna. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop antenna
Miscellaneous
Power Requirements
. . AC 110–120 V/220–230 V/240 V, 50/60 Hz
Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 W
Power Consumption
Dimensions . . . . 284 (W) x 59 (D) x 110 (H) cm
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg
in standby mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.55 W
Dimensions:
DVD/CD Tuner . 360 (W) x 74 (H) x 270 (D) mm
Display Unit. . . . . 274 (W) x 44 (H) x 35 (D) mm
Weight:
DVD/CD Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.2 kg
Display Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0.2 kg
94
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Additional information
12
Satellite Speaker System
(S-DV900ST)
Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flat panel type bookshelf
Speaker
• Specifications and design subject to
possible modification without notice, due
to improvements.
Exciter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5 cm exciter x 3
Tweeter . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm (semi-dome type)
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 – 35,000 Hz
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)
Front / Surround speakers
Dimensions . . . . 120 (W) x 30 (D) x 450 (H) cm
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.9 kg
Center speaker
This product includes FontAvenue®
fonts licenced by NEC corporation.
FontAvenue is a registered trademark
of NEC Corporation.
Dimensions . . . . 420 (W) x 32 (D) x 120 (H) cm
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.9 kg
The S-DV900ST satellite speakers are flat-panel-
type units that use NXT® speaker technology.
These slim style speakers allow for easy
installation anywhere.
NXT and the
logo are registered
trademarks of New Transducers Limited.
Powered subwoofer
(S-DV700SW/S-DV900SW)
Type. . . . . . Bass reflex floor type, antimagnetic
Speaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 cm (cone type)
Nominal impedence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 – 2,300 Hz
Max. input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 W (JEITA)
Dimensions . . . 192 (W) x 436 (D) x 395 (H) cm
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.5 kg
95
En
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
5 cm
28 cm
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
感謝惠購先鋒產品。
請通讀使用說明書以了解本型號的正確操作方法。通讀完畢後,請妥善保存,以備日後參考。
目錄
01 開始使用之前
以立體聲模式收聽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
用耳機收聽
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
家庭影院使用說明
使用高級環繞聲效果
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
調節高級環繞聲效果等級 . . . . . . . . . . . .33
增強對話
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
一般碟片兼容性
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
CD-R/RW 兼容性. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
兼容性
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
用虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲器收聽 . . . . . . . . . .34
DVD-R/RW
PC 製作碟片的兼容性 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
. . . . . . . . . . . . .34
使用安靜和午夜聽音模式
調節低音和高音
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
壓縮音頻兼容性
文件兼容性
增強低音等級 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
JPEG
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
靜音
02 控制按鈕和顯示
前面板 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
播放碟片
05
介紹
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片內容. . . . . . . . . . . .37
掃描碟片
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
顯示幕裝置
顯示幕
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
慢動作播放
遙控器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
逐幀前進/逐幀倒退 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
循環播放碟片上的某一段
03
開機和設置
開始使用
. . . . . . . . . . . . .40
使用重複播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
設置時鐘
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
使用
使用顯示幕
設置遙控器以控制電視機. . . . . . . . . . . . 20
使用房間設置
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
使用隨機播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
使用
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
使用螢幕顯示. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
創建編序列表
播放碟片
基本播放控制按鈕
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
使用 OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
恢復和最終記憶 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
使用本機顯示幕
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
碟片選單
DVD
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
選單
清除編序列表
超級
的
VCD/
VCD
PBC
. . . . . . . . . 26
搜索碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
播放 唱碟的 “附送類”
收聽收音機. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
改善不良的 接收
DVD
. . . . . . . . . . .47
FM
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
收聽預設電臺. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
收聽其他播放源
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
切換字幕 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
記憶電臺
切換
切換
影碟伴音語言
DVD
DVD
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
唱碟的音頻聲道
. . . . . . . . . . . .48
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
切換 VCD /超級 VCD 的音頻聲道 . . . . . .48
放大屏幕畫面
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
04 家庭影院的聲效
自動聽音模式. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
切換視角
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
用環繞聲進行收聽
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
音樂設定
杜比
Pro Logic II
. . . . . . . . . . 31
5
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Options
Parental Lock
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
(選項)
顯示碟片資訊
碟片資訊
(家長鎖定)
. . . . . . . . . .67
OSD
顯示幕資訊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Bonus Group (附送類). . . . . . . . . . . .69
(自動碟片選單)
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
. . . .70
(分組播放)
. . . . . . . .70
06
播放
JPEG
碟片
觀看
JPEG
DVD Playback Mode DVD
70
播放模式)
碟片
(
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
(
播放)
. . . . . . .71
SACD Playback SACD
使用
碟片導向和圖片瀏覽器
JPEG
放大屏幕畫面
. . . . . . 52
PhotoViewer (圖片瀏覽器) . . . . . . . .71
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
11
其它連接
連接外接天線
連接輔助設備
07
使用定時器
設置喚醒定時器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
開啟/關閉喚醒定時器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
降低電視機和線路信號電平 . . . . . . . . . .73
錄音模式
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
設置睡眠定時器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
使用 視頻輸出端進行連接
S
. . . . . . . . . . . .74
環繞聲設定
08
設定環繞聲
使用設備視頻輸出進行連接. . . . . . . . . . . .75
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
系統設定選單選項 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
設置聲道等級
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
12
附加資訊
關閉演示
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
童鎖
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
視頻調節
選單
(Video Adjust)
09
視頻調節
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
改變時鐘格式
改變頻率等級
(Video Adjust) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
創建您自己的預設項 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
設置電視制式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
制電視機 ( )上觀看
在
PAL
MOD.PAL
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
重置本系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
10
初始設置
使用初始設置
(Initial Settings)
選單
選單
. . . . 62
節目
NTSC
(Initial Settings)
(數位音頻模
Digital Audio Mode Settings
調節顯示幕亮度
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
式設定)
使用和保護碟片
(杜比數位輸出)
Dolby Digital Out
. . 62
標題,章和曲目 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
影碟區域
DTS Out (DTS 輸出) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
DVD
拿取碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
(線性
輸出)
PCM . . . 63
Linear PCM Out
(視頻輸出設置)
63
Video Output settings
存儲碟片
不可使用的碟片
TV Screen (TV 屏幕). . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
本系統正確安裝和維護 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
安裝提示
(分量輸出)
Component Out
. . . . . . . 64
(
S
視頻輸出)
. . . . . . . . . 65
S-Video Out
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
清潔拾取頭
Language settings (語言設置) . . . . . . 65
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
關於結露問題 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
搬移本機
(伴音語言)
. . . . . . . 65
Audio Language
(字幕語言)
Subtitle Language
. . . . . 65
選單語言)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
電源線注意事項
DVD Menu Language DVD
(
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81
66
Subtitle Display (字幕顯示) . . . . . . . 66
(顯示設置)
Display settings
OSD Language OSD
On Screen Display
. . . . . . . . 66
語言)
(
. . . . . . . 66
. . . . . 66
(螢幕顯示)
(角度指示器)
Angle Indicator
. . . . . . 67
6
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
故障排除
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
一般. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
播放機
DVD/CD/VCD
MP3/JPEG
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
碟片
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
調諧器
錯誤訊息
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
屏幕尺寸和碟片格式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
寬屏電視機用戶
標準電視機用戶
使用語言代碼列表選擇語言. . . . . . . . . . . 87
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
語言代碼列表
國家 地區 代碼列表
(
)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
預設代碼列表. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
術語
規格
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
7
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
開始使用之前
第 1 章
開始使用之前
圖像放大
功能
在播放DVD或VCD/超級VCD時,您能夠放大
圖像的任一部分仔細觀看,最大可放大到 4
倍。請參見第48頁“放大屏幕畫面”。
DVD
SACD
兼容
使您可體驗DVD唱碟和超級CD唱碟(SACD)
唱碟和
超凡的高品質音頻性能。
MP3
兼容
板載24bit/192kHz DAC的使用意味著本播放
機與高取樣率的碟片完全兼容,從而在動態範
圍、低電平解析和高頻細節方面能夠提供極佳
的音質。
本播放機可兼容含有 MP3 音頻曲目的 CD-R、
CD-RW和CD-ROM碟片。請參見第10頁“壓縮
音頻兼容性”。
圖形化螢幕顯示
圖形化螢幕顯示讓您能夠十分輕鬆地設置和
使用您的DVD家庭影院系統。
采用杜比數位、杜比專業邏輯、杜比專業邏
*1
*2
II
DTS
輯
和
軟體的卓越音頻性能
節能設計
本系統處於待機模式時的設計功耗為0.55 W。
內置式杜比數位和DTS解碼器讓您能夠享受到
帶杜比數位和DTS編碼的DVD碟片所具有的真
正獨立多聲道家庭影院聲音效果。
*1 經杜比實驗室授權生產。“Dolby”、“Pro
Logic”及雙D標誌是杜比實驗室的商標。
杜比專業邏輯和杜比專業邏輯II解碼方式通
過環繞聲播放,為雙聲道播放源資料增添了極
大的震撼力。
*2 “DTS”和“DTS Digital Surround”為數
碼影院系統公司(Digital Theater
Systems,Inc.)的註冊商標。
環繞聲音效的簡易房間設置
通過房間設置功能,僅使用兩個步驟即可設置
基本的環繞聲音效。告知本機您聽音房間的大
小以及您的聽音位置後,系統即能自動配置環
繞聲音效。
8
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
開始使用之前
家庭影院使用說明
一般碟片兼容性
本機設計為可與帶有以下一個或幾個標誌的
您可能習慣於使用立體聲設備來收聽音樂而
從來沒有用過家庭影院系統,後者可以在您收
聽曲目時向您提供更多的可選項目(如環繞
聲)。
軟體兼容︰
家庭影院是指利用多音軌來創造一種環繞聲
效果,讓您感到自己正處於動作場景或者音樂
會的中心位置。來源於家庭影院系統的環繞聲
不僅取決於您在房間內所安放的揚聲器情況,
還取決於播放源以及系統的聲音設置。
由於其尺寸,質量以及使用便捷的特點,DVD
影碟已成為家庭影院的基本播放源資料。視
DVD而定,您可以從一張碟片中獲得多達6種
不同的音軌,而所有音軌將被發送到您系統的
各個揚聲器中。這就是環繞聲效果的創造方
式,可以給您以身臨其境的感受。
本機將根據您的揚聲器設置情況,自動對杜比
數位,DTS或杜比環繞DVD影碟進行解碼。在
大多數情況下,您將無需改變即可獲得逼真的
環繞聲,但在第30 頁“家庭影院的聲效”中
將對其他效果進行說明(如用多聲道環繞聲
收聽CD)。
•
•
KODAK Picture CD
是Fuji Photo Film公司的商標。
本播放機支持IEC之超級VCD標準。與影音CD
標準相比,超級VCD可提供卓越的畫質,並可
進行兩條立體聲音軌的錄製。超級VCD還支持
寬螢幕尺寸。
VIDEO
CD
其他格式(包括但不限於下列格式)不能在
本機上播放︰
*
DVD-RAM / DVD-ROM / CD-ROM
* 除那些含有MP3或JPEG的以外。請參見壓縮
音頻兼容性和JPEG文件兼容性。
9
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
開始使用之前
使用 DVD 錄製機,CD 錄製機或個人電腦錄製
的DVD-R/RW和CD-R/RW碟片(CD唱碟和VCD)
可能不能在本機上播放。其原因可能有眾多,
包括但不限於:使用的碟片類型;錄製類型;
碟片或播放機拾取鏡頭的損壞,塵垢或結露。
有關專用軟體和格式的注意事項,請參見下
文。
製作碟片的兼容性
PC
如果您用個人電腦錄製碟片,即使該碟片
是以前述的“兼容格式”錄製的,也可能
由於製作碟片的應用程式的設置問題而無
法在本機上播放。遇到此類情況請向軟體
發行商咨詢詳情。
•
檢查DVD-R/RW或CD-R/RW軟體碟片包裝盒,
以獲得更多的有關兼容方面的資訊。
•
CD-R/RW
兼容性
本機能夠播放以CD唱碟或VCD格式錄製的
CD-R和CD-RW碟片,或將其作為含有MP3
或JPEG 文件的CD-ROM進行播放。但是,
任何其他內容都會使碟片無法播放或使輸
出產生噪音/失真。
•
壓縮音頻兼容性
本機能夠播放取樣率為32、44.1或48kHz且
其中所含文件以 MPEG-1音頻層 3(MP3)
格式保存的CD-ROM、CD-R和CD-RW碟片。
•
不兼容的文件將不能播放,且會顯示
Can't
(無法播放此格式)的
play this format
本機無法錄製CD-R或CD-RW碟片。
•
•
訊息〔顯示幕上顯示“
”(不播
No Play
本機能夠播放作為CD唱碟錄製的未經最終
完成的CD-R/RW碟片,但無法顯示其完整
的目錄(播放時間等)。
放)〕。
我們推薦採用固定位元率的MP3文件。可變
位元率(VBR)的 MP3 文件能夠被播放,
但播放時間可能無法正確顯示。
•
兼容性
DVD-R/RW
本機能夠播放以DVD影碟格式錄製並用DVD
•
• 用於編輯MP3文件的CD-ROM必須符合ISO
9660 Level 1或2要求。CD 物理格式︰模
式1,模式2 XA Form 1。本播放機同時兼
容Romeo與Joliet文件系統。
錄製機最終完成的DVD-R/RW碟片。
本機能夠播放用視頻錄製(VR)格式錄製
的DVD-RW碟片。
•
• 請使用CD-R或CD-RW碟片錄製您的文件。碟
片必須最終完成(即片段必須結束)以便
能在本機上播放。本播放機不兼容多片段
碟片。本機只識別多片段碟片的第1個片
段。
• 裝入VR格式的DVD-RW碟片後,顯示幕將顯
示DVD-RW。
• 播放由DVD錄製機編輯的VR格式的DVD-RW
碟片時,在編輯點處螢幕可能暫時變黑,
並且/或者您可能會看見編輯點位置前面
的畫面。
本播放機僅播放文件擴展名為.mp3或.MP3
的曲目。
•
本機無法錄製DVD-R/RW碟片。
•
•
命名MP3文件時,請加上相應的文件擴展名
(.mp3)。文件根據文件擴展名播放。為了
防止噪聲和故障,請勿對其他種類的文件
使用這些擴展名。
•
本播放機無法播放未最終完成的DVD-R/RW
碟片。
10
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
01
開始使用之前
本播放機最多可識別999個文件(MP3/
JPEG)和499個文件夾。如果碟片中的文
件或文件夾數超過這個限制,則最多只能
播放限制數目內的文件或文件夾。文件和
文件夾以字母順序讀取/顯示。請注意,
如果文件結構較為複雜,您可能不能讀取
/播放碟片上的所有文件。
•
•
文件夾和曲目名稱(不包括文件擴展名)
將被顯示。
• 對MP3文件編碼可有許多不同的錄製位元
率。本機設計可與它們全部兼容。以
128Kbps編碼的音頻接近常規的CD音質。
本播放機能夠播放低位元率的文件,但請
注意,在低位元率時音質將明顯下降。
文件兼容性
JPEG
•
本機支持最高為8百萬像素的基線JPEG和
EXIF 2.1* 靜像文件(最大垂直和水平分
辨率為5120 像素)。(* 數位相機所用文
件格式)
• 用於編輯JPEG文件的CD-ROM必須符合ISO
9660 Level 1 或2要求。CD物理格式︰模
式1,模式2 XA Form 1。本播放機同時兼
容Romeo與Joliet 文件系統。
• 本播放機只播放文件擴展名為.jpg或.JPG
的文件。
11
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
第 2 章
控制按鈕和顯示
前面板
1
2
3
TIMER
STANDBY/ON
OPEN/CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢂ
4
6
7
5
8
5 ꢂ STANDBY/ON
按該按鈕開啟系統或將其切換至待機狀態。
1 VOLUME 按鈕
用於調節音量。
2
按該按鈕停止播放。
ꢀ
碟片托盤
6
7
ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
3
ꢁ
按該按鈕將打開/關閉碟片托盤。
DVD/CD
按該按鈕切換至
開始/暫停/恢復播放。
定時器指示器
功能。也可以用於
插孔
8 PHONES
耳機插孔。
4
在設置好喚醒定時器後亮起(第54頁)。
顯示幕裝置
9
10
遙感窗
顯示幕
10
9
詳情請參見第13頁“顯示幕”。
12
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
顯示幕
3
5
1
2
4
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
14
MIDNIGHT QUIET
PGM RPT-1
RDM
V.PART
ATT
REC MODE
PRO LOGIC
DIGITAL
ADV.SURR.
PRGSVE
kHz
MHz
20
19
18 17 16 15
8
V.PART
當播放DVD碟片的視頻部分時亮起。
ATT
調諧器指示器
1
9
接收廣播時亮起。
啟動輸入衰減器以進行當前所選的模擬輸入
時亮起(第73頁)。
以自動立體聲模式接收立體聲FM廣播時亮
起。
10 REC MODE
開啟錄製模式時亮起(第74頁)。
FM單聲道接收被選定時亮起。
定時器指示器
11
2
ꢄ
播放碟片時亮起。
MIDNIGHT
午夜模式被選定時亮起(第34頁)。
設置好喚醒定時器後亮起(第54頁)。
啟動睡眠定時器時亮起( 第56 頁)。
3
4
QUIET
安靜模式被選定時亮起(第34頁)。
PGM
編序列表被編序時亮起(第43頁)。
12 2 PRO LOGIC II
在杜比PRO LOGIC解碼期間亮起 (第30頁)。
5
13 2DIGITAL
在播放杜比數位播放源期間亮起(第30頁)。
和
6
RPT
RPT-1
RPT
亮起( 第40 頁)。
在重複播放期間
亮起。在單曲重複播放
期間
RPT-1
RDM
在隨機播放期間亮起( 第42 頁)。
7
13
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
揚聲器指示器
14
這些指示器表示正用於輸出當前播放源的揚
聲器。下圖表示若干顯示實例。
5.1聲道環繞聲
立體聲(2.1聲道)
帶中央聲道對話增強的3.1聲道
聲音
啟動了虛擬後置環繞聲模式的5.1
聲道環繞聲
15 PRGSVE
逐行掃描視頻輸出被選定時亮起(第64頁)。
16 ADV.SURR.
一種高級環繞聲聽音模式被選定時亮起(第32
頁)。
17 DTS
在播放DTS播放源期間亮起(第30頁)。
18 kHz / MHz
表明字符顯示幕中所顯示的頻率單位(
kHz
用
於AM,
用於FM)。
MHz
19 字符顯示幕
20
DVD碟片上出現多視角場景時亮起(第49頁)。
14
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
3
DISPLAY
遙控器
按該按鈕顯示/改變螢幕顯示的碟片資訊(第
49頁)。
STANDBY/ON
FM/AM
1
2
CD
L1/L2
LINE
4
碟片播放控制按鈕
DVD
TUNER
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN/CLOSE
ꢄ
ꢃ
3
4
5
6
7
ꢋ
11
按該按鈕開始或恢復播放。
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
和
ꢅ
ꢆ/ꢇ
12
13
DVD MENU
RETURN
用於進行向後慢放,逐幀倒退和倒退掃描。
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ꢈ 和 ꢉ/ꢊ
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
用於進行向前慢放,逐幀前進以及向前掃
描。
8
9
14
MASTER
VOLUME
ꢋ
TV CONTROL
按該按鈕暫停播放;再次按重新開始播放。
10
15
CH
INPUT
VOL
ꢀ
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
按該按鈕停止播放。
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
5
ꢌ
16
17
18
19
20
21
HOME
MENU
按該按鈕將跳至當前章/曲目的開始處,然後
跳至前一章/曲目。
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
SETUP
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
4
6
DVD MENU
22
QUIET/
TIMER/
CLOCK
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
8
9
如果裝入了一張 VR 格式的 DVD-RW,CD,VCD
/超級VCD,MP3或JPEG碟片,按該按鈕則顯
示DVD碟片選單或碟片導航器。
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
光標按鈕,
和調諧按鈕
ENTER
7
光標按鈕
使用光標按鈕(ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ)導向螢幕顯
示和選單。
• 遙控器上印製呈綠色的功能可通過將
MAIN/SUB 開關切換至SUB 獲得。
ENTER
1
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
按該按鈕選擇某一選項或者執行某一命
令。
按該按鈕開啟系統或切換至待機狀態。
TUNE +/–
功能選擇按鈕
2
按這些按鈕選擇您要收聽的播放源〔
用於調諧收音機。
DVD
,
, , 〕
(CD) TUNER TV LINE
15
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
ST +/–
SURROUND
收聽收音機時用於選擇預設的電臺。
用於選擇環繞聲模式(第30 頁)。
8
9
MUTE
ADVANCED
按該按鈕使各揚聲器和耳機中的所有聲音
靜音(再按則取消靜音)(第36頁)。
用於選擇高級環繞聲(第32 頁)。
(副功能)
MASTER VOLUME
BASS MODE
用於調節音量。
用於選擇低音模式( 第35頁)。
(第20頁)
10 TV CONTROL
DIALOGUE
用於選擇對話模式( 第33頁)。
ꢂ
按該按鈕打開電視機或切換至待機狀態。
VIRTUAL SB
INPUT
按該按鈕開啟/關閉虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲
器效果(第34 頁)。
按該按鈕切換至電視機輸入。
CH +/–
16 DVD/CD
按鈕
用於選擇電視機頻道。
(主功能)
VOL +/–
AUDIO
用於調節電視機的音量。
按該按鈕選擇音頻聲道或伴音語言(第47
頁)。
11 ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
按該按鈕打開/關閉碟片托盤。
SUBTITLE
按該按鈕顯示/改變DVD字幕顯示(第47
頁)。
12 ꢍ
按該按鈕跳至下一章/曲目。
ANGLE
13 RETURN
按該按鈕在進行DVD多視角場景播放期間
改變攝像機視角(第49 頁)。
按該按鈕返回前一選單畫面。
14 SOUND
(副功能)
按該按鈕進入聲音選單,您可以從中調節DSP
效果等級,低音和高音等選項。
PROGRAM
用於編序/播放編序列表(第43 頁)。
15
環繞聲模式/聲音增強按鈕
(主功能)
REPEAT
用於選擇重複播放模式( 第40頁)。
AUTO
RANDOM
用於選擇隨機播放模式( 第42頁)。
按該按鈕為當前播放源選擇預設解碼方式
(第30頁)。
16
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
02
控制按鈕和顯示
(副功能)
(副功能)
17
ZOOM
FOLDER –
按該按鈕改變畫面縮放比率(第48頁)。
按該按鈕跳至前一文件夾。
TOP MENU
FOLDER +
用於顯示播放位置處的DVD碟片的頂層選
單(這可能和按下DVD MENU 的效果相
按該按鈕跳至後一文件夾。
21 MAIN / SUB
同)。
從
改變至
可進入遙控器上印製呈
SUB
MAIN
HOME MENU
綠色的功能。
按該按鈕顯示(或退出)初始設置,播放
模式功能等項目的螢幕顯示選單。
(主功能)
ROOM SETUP
(副功能)
18
19
20
按該按鈕開始房間設置( 第20 頁)。
SYSTEM SETUP
22
(主功能)
用於進行多種系統和環繞聲設置(第57頁)。
數字按鈕
TEST TONE
使用數字按鈕直接選擇碟片中的標題/章
用於輸出測試音(設定揚聲器用)( 第59
頁)。
/曲目。
CH LEVEL
用於調節揚聲器等級( 第59頁)。
(副功能)
DIMMER
按該按鈕使顯示幕變暗或變亮。
QUIET/MIDNIGHT
用於選擇安靜模式和午夜模式(第34頁)。
TIMER/CLOCK
按該按鈕顯示時鐘或進入定時器選單(第
19頁和第54 頁)。
(主功能)
CLR
按該按鈕清除輸入。
ENTER
選擇選單選項等。(和上文第
條中的
7
按鈕效果完全一樣)。
ENTER
17
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
第 3 章
開始使用
您應看到顯示歡迎畫面。
開機和設置
在確認所有設備連接正確後,可準備開機。首
先需確認您使用的電視機種類,標準或寬屏。
Welcome to Pioneer DVD!
Thank you for purchasing this Pioneer DVD player.
在此之後,您可為您的房間設置環繞聲,並可
設置時鐘以便使用定時器功能。
Before using, please take a little time
to setup your DVD player
Put the batteries into the remote control
Next, press the [ENTER] button on the remote control
and start the Let's Get Started Menu
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
Next
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
2
3
ENTER
按
移至下一畫面。
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
根據您的電視機種類用
(左/右
ꢂ/ꢃ
光標)按鈕選擇 “
(
)”
Standard size screen
)”〔標準尺寸屏幕 ( )〕,然後按
Wide Screen 16:9
DVD MENU
RETURN
〔寬屏 (
16:9
)〕或 “
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
(
4:3 4:3
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
。
ENTER
如果無法確定如何選擇,請同時參見第 87 頁
MASTER
VOLUME
“屏幕尺寸和碟片格式”。
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
Let's Get Started Menu
What kind of TV do you have?
1
按 ꢂ STANDBY/ON(在遙控器或前面板
上)打開系統。
Use the
/
cursor buttons
to choose, then press [ENTER]
同時請確認電視機已打開且視頻輸出已連至
本系統。
Wide screen (16:9)
Standard size screen (4:3)
18
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
再次按
結束設置。
ENTER
4
設置時鐘
設置時鐘將使您能夠使用定時器功能。
Let's Get Started Menu
STANDBY/ON
Setup complete
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
If you're finished setting up,
choose [Complete],
DVD
TV
to start again choose [Back]
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
Complete
Back
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
如果您要返回並改變先前進行的設置,請
使用 (右光標)按鈕選擇
•
•
ENTER
後再按
Back
ꢃ
MUTE
SOUND
。
ENTER
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
您還可以使用功能按鈕(
,
DVD/CD
按鈕將系
ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
等)或
TUNER
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
統從待機狀態切換至開啟狀態。
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
按
。
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK
如果您在調節時鐘但非初次進行設置,請
•
再次按
。
TIMER/CLOCK
如果顯示幕中尚未出現 “Clock ADJ?”,
請按 ꢂ 或 ꢃ (左光標或右光標)直至您看
見該資訊為止。
3
4
5
ENTER
。
按
使用
(上/下光標)按鈕設定小時。
ꢀ/ꢁ
按
。
ENTER
19
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
使用
(上/下光標)按鈕設定分鐘。
6
7
ꢀ/ꢁ
MASTER
VOLUME
按 ENTER 進行確認。
TV CONTROL
顯示幕閃爍表示時鐘已被設定。
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
AUTO
VIRTUAL SB
SURROUND ADVANCED
• 任何時候按TIMER/CLOCK 將顯示時鐘。
按鈕
功能
ꢂ
打開電視機或切換至待機狀態。
改變電視機頻道。
CH +/–
VOL +/–
INPUT
如果從牆面插座上拔出系統的插頭或發生
停電,您將需要重新設定時鐘。
•
調節音量。
在內置式電視調諧器和外部視
頻播放源之間切換電視機輸入。
設置遙控器以控制電視機
您可以通過使用
按鈕對隨機提
TV CONTROL
供的遙控器進行設置以控制電視機。
預設狀態為先鋒電視機。
•
開啟電視機。
1
2
在第 89 頁上的預設代碼列表中找出電視
使用房間設置
機的製造商名稱。
在使用您的系統來欣賞環繞聲播放之前,建議
您花幾分鐘時間來使用房間設置。要為您的房
間營造良好的環繞聲,這不失為一個快捷的方
法。
各製造商之後是一個或多個三位數代碼。這些
代碼會將您的電視機種類資訊傳達至遙控器。
如果您的電視機製造商名稱沒有出現在表中,
您將無法設置該遙控器控制電視機。
根據您的主要收聽位置到環繞聲揚聲器的距
離,可在 (小), (中)或 (大)房間
將遙控器對著電視機,按住
按鈕,然
3
後輸入您電視機的三位數代碼。
CLR
S
M
L
中進行選擇,然後根據座位到前置揚聲器和環
繞聲揚聲器的相對位置,選擇 (前方),
遙控器向電視機發射開/關信號。如果您已輸
入了正確代碼,則電視機應該關閉。
Fwd
(後方)。
Back
(中間)或者
Mid
如果您的電視機沒有關閉,請使用列表中的下
一代碼重複該步驟,直至您的電視機成功關
閉。一旦設置完畢,您接著就可使用如下所示
的各個電視機控制按鈕。
20
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
如果系統尚未開啟,請按
1
ꢂ STANDBY/
使用螢幕顯示
開啟。
ON
為了方便使用,本機大量使用圖形化螢幕顯示
(OSD)。您應該熟悉該工作方式,因為當您設
置播放機,使用某些播放功能(如編序播放)
以及對音頻和視頻進行更高級的設定時,您需
要用到它們。
2
按 ROOM SETUP。
• 如果您以前已設置好房間類型和座位位
置,顯示幕將顯示當前房間設置。
3
4
ENTER
。
按
所有畫面基本上都以相同的方法導航︰用光
使用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇房間
標按鈕( , , , )改變高亮項目,
ꢀ ꢁ ꢂ ꢃ
ꢀ/ꢁ
按ENTER 選定。
類型,然後按
。
ENTER
根據您的房間大小選擇以下之一:
• S —小於普通房間
• M —普通房間
在本說明書中,“選定”的意思是用光標
按鈕高亮顯示一個項目,再按
•
• L
—大於普通房間
。
ENTER
使用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇座位
5
ꢀ/ꢁ
設置,然後按
。
ENTER
根據您的主要收聽位置選擇以下之一:
—與環繞聲揚聲器相比,如果您更靠
• Fwd
近前置揚聲器
• Mid —如果您到環繞聲揚聲器的距離和到
前置揚聲器的距離相同
• Back —與前置揚聲器相比,如果您更靠近
環繞聲揚聲器
房間設置自動設置聲道等級和揚聲器距
離。如果您已經手動設置了聲道等級(請
參見第 59 頁)或揚聲器距離(請參見第
58頁),則在初次按下 ROOM SETUP 按
鈕後將看到顯示幕中出現Room Set?。
•
• 使用房間設置功能將覆蓋所有以前設置的
聲道等級和揚聲器距離。
• 有關環繞聲設定的詳細說明,請參見第57
頁“設定環繞聲”。
21
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢄ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢈ
每個 OSD畫面底部的按鈕指南顯示在該畫
面中所需用到的按鈕。
•
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
ENTER
播放碟片
MUTE
SOUND
此處說明的是播放DVD,CD,SACD,VCD/超
級VCD和MP3碟片的基本播放控制功能。更多
的功能將在第5 章詳述。
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
在本說明書中,“DVD”表示所有種類的
DVD碟片(DVD影碟、DVD唱碟或DVD-R/RW)。
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
如果播放機尚未打開,請按
SYSTEM
1
ꢂ STANDBY/
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
打開播放機。
QUIET/
TIMER/
ON
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
如果您播放的是DVD或VCD/超級VCD,同時
也請打開您的電視機,並確認電視機已設定到
正確的視頻輸入上。
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
按
打開碟片托盤。
2
3
ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
裝入碟片。
按鈕
功能
裝入碟片時應使碟片的標籤面向上。用碟片托
盤導軌對準碟片(如果您裝入的是一張雙面
DVD碟片,請將欲播放的一面向下)。
HOME
MENU
顯示/退出螢幕顯示
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ
改變高亮選單項目
ENTER
選定高亮顯示的選單項目 (兩個
ENTER 按鈕作用相同)
RETURN
不保存改變而返回主選單
22
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
按
(播放)開始播放。
4
ꢄ
基本播放控制按鈕
下表說明了遙控器上播放碟片用的基本控制
如果您播放的是DVD或VCD/超級VCD,可能
會有一個選單出現。關於如何使用選單的更多
資訊,請參見第25 頁“DVD碟片選單”和第
26頁“VCD/超級VCD的PBC 選單”。
按鈕。更多的播放功能將在第5 章詳細說明。
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
如果您播放的是MP3碟片,根據碟片上文件結
構的複雜程度,播放開始前可能需要幾秒鐘的
時間。
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
如果您裝入的是一張包括JPEG文件的CD/CD-
R/RW,圖片會開始逐張放映。關於播放這些碟
片的更多資訊,請參見第52頁“觀看JPEG碟
片”。
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
•
如果碟片同時包括MP3音頻文件和JPEG圖
像文件,請同時參見第71頁“PhotoViewer
(圖片瀏覽器)”。
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
使用
按鈕 (或前
5
面板
MASTER VOLUME -/+
CH
INPUT
VOL
按鈕)調節音量。
VOLUME
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
按鈕
功能
開始播放。
ꢄ
DVD和VCD︰如果顯示幕顯示
Resume (恢復)或 Last Mem
(最終記憶),播放將從恢復位
置或最終記憶位置開始播放 (請
同時參見“恢復和最終記
憶”)。
23
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
按鈕
功能
ꢋ
暫停正在播放的碟片,或重新開
始播放一張暫停的碟片。
您可能發現,對某些DVD 碟片上的特定部
分,一些播放按鈕不起作用。這不是故障。
•
•
ꢀ
停止播放。
DVD和VCD︰顯示幕顯示
對於未最終完成的CD-R/RW碟片,用於曲目
選擇的曲目跳躍和數字按鈕不起作用。
Resume
ꢀ
(恢復)。再按 (停
止)按鈕取消恢復功能。(請參
見以下“恢復和最終記憶”。)
使用前面板控制按鈕
前面板上的
,
和
ꢃ OPEN/CLOSE
ꢁ
ꢀ
ꢅ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢍ
按此按鈕開始快速反向掃描。按
ꢄ
(停止)按鈕的作用與遙控器上相應按鈕的
作用完全相同。
(播放)恢復正常播放。
按此按鈕開始快速正向掃描。按
ꢄ (播放)恢復正常播放。
恢復和最終記憶
當您停止一張DVD或VCD碟片的播放時,顯示
跳到當前曲目或章的開始處,然
後至前一曲目/章。
幕中顯示
(恢復),這表示您可以再
Resume
跳到下一曲目或章。
次從該點開始恢復播放。
FOLDER +/-
(SUB)
播放JPEG或MP3碟片時跳至前一/
下一文件夾。
如果碟片托盤未打開,當您在下一次開始播放
時,顯示幕中顯示
從恢復點恢復。
(恢復),且播放
Resume
數字
用於輸入標題/曲目/分組/章
號碼。按 ENTER 以選擇(或等待
數秒鐘)。
僅對DVD碟片︰如果您從播放機上取出碟片,
播放位置將存入記憶體。當您在下次裝入該碟
片時,顯示幕將顯示Last Mem(最終記憶),
• 如果碟片被停止播放,將從所
選的標題/分組(對於DVD影碟
/DVD唱碟)或曲目號碼(對於
這時您可以恢復播放(這個功能最多可用於5
張碟片)。
超級VCD/MP3
SACD/CD/VCD/
開始播放。
)
如果您想清除恢復/最終記憶點,請在
Resume 或Last Mem 出現時按ꢀ(停止)
•
如果碟片正在播放,將跳至所選
的章或曲目(對於DVD唱碟,位
於當前分組內)開始處進行播放。
按鈕。
當裝入VCD時,如果播放機被關閉或切換至
DVD (CD) 以外的功能時,恢復點將丟失。
•
• 為了使用最終記憶功能,在打開碟片托盤
前請務必按 ꢀ (停止)停止播放。
24
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
對於DVD唱碟,沒有恢復和最終記憶功能。
我的電視機是標準屏幕(4:3),並將播放
機設定為以全景掃描(pan & scan)格式
顯示寬屏 DVD,那為什么在播放一些碟片
時頂部和底部仍有黑條?
•
•
•
最終記憶功能對VR格式的DVD-RW碟片不起
作用。
• 對於MP3格式碟片,播放無法恢復,而是從
播放停止時正在播放的文件所在文件夾的
首個曲目開始播放。
某些碟片忽略播放機的首選顯示方式,這
樣即使您選擇了 4:3 (Pan & Scan),那些
碟片仍以信箱格式顯示畫面。這不是故障。
• 為什么我不能通過數位亮起輸出聽到 DVD
唱碟和SACD的音頻?
DVD碟片裝入後過幾秒鐘自動退出﹗
•
DVD唱碟和SACD音頻僅通過模擬輸出端輸
出。這並非故障。
最大的可能是碟片不符合播放機的區域。
碟片上應印有區域號,請與播放機的區域
號(您可以在後面板上找到它)進行核
對。請參見第78頁“DVD影碟區域”。
我的DVD唱碟開始播放,但隨後突然停止﹗
該碟片可能是非法拷貝的。
•
如果區域號正確,則可能是碟片損壞或髒
了。請清潔碟片並查看是否有損壞的跡象。
請參見第78頁“使用和保護碟片”。
DVD
碟片選單
許多DVD影碟和DVD唱碟帶有選單,您可以通
過該選單選擇要觀看或收聽的內容。這些選單
可能還提供附加功能,例如字幕和伴音語言選
擇,或者某些特殊功能,例如圖片放映。詳情
請參見碟片包裝上的說明。
為什么裝入的碟片無法播放?
•
首先請檢查碟片的裝入方式是否正確(標
籤面向上),再檢查碟片是否清潔或有損
壞。關於碟片的清潔請參見第 78 頁“使
用和保護碟片”。
有時DVD的選單會在您開始播放時自動顯示,
有時則僅在您按
時顯示。
或
DVD MENU
TOP MENU
如果碟片裝入正確但無法播放,則可能是
格式或碟片類型不兼容,如 DVD-ROM。關
於碟片兼容性的更多資訊請參見第 9 頁
“一般碟片兼容性”。
某些DVD唱碟具有附送類。要獲取這些分
組,您必須輸入碟片包裝上的密碼。詳情
請參見第69頁。
•
我的電視機是寬屏型,那為什么在播放一
些碟片時屏幕頂部和底部有黑條?
•
某些電影格式即使在寬屏電視機上播放,
屏幕頂部和底部仍需有黑條。這不是故障。
25
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
DVD MENU
RETURN
SOUND
超級
的
選單
VCD/
VCD PBC
一些 VCD/ 超級 VCD 含有選單,您能夠從這個
選單中選擇您想觀看的內容。它們被稱為PBC
(播放控制)選單。
ENTER
MUTE
MASTER
VOLUME
播放帶PBC的VCD/超級VCD時,您可以不用
TV CONTROL
導向PBC 選單,而是先按 (停止)按鈕,
ꢀ
然後使用數字按鈕選擇曲目但不是
(播
ꢄ
CH
INPUT
VOL
放)按鈕(或前面板上的
)開始播放。
ꢁ
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
ꢌ
ꢌ
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
DVD MENU
RETURN
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
TUNE+
4
ST–
ST+
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ENTER
8
9
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
按鈕
功能
TOP MENU
顯示DVD碟片的“頂層選單”
-隨碟片而異。
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
DVD
MENU
顯示DVD碟片選單-隨碟片而異,
並可能與“頂層選單”相同。
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
ꢂꢀꢁꢃ
ENTER
在屏幕上移動光標。
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
選定當前的選單選項。
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
RETURN
返回至先前顯示的選單畫面。對
某些具有可瀏覽圖片的DVD唱碟,
按該按鈕將顯示瀏覽器畫面。
數字
(主功能) 於某些碟片)。按
高亮顯示編號的選單選項 (僅適
以進行
ENTER
選擇(或等待數秒鐘)。
26
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
按鈕
功能
收聽收音機
調諧器可以接收FM和AM廣播,並記憶您最喜
歡的電臺,從而無需每次在想要收聽時進行手
動調諧。
RETURN
顯示 PBC選單。
數字按鈕
ꢌ
選擇數字選單項目。
顯示前一選單頁(如果有的話)。
顯示後一選單頁(如果有的話)。
按下選定高亮顯示的選單項目。
STANDBY/ON
ꢍ
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
ENTER
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
如果系統尚未開啟,請按
開啟。
1
ꢂ STANDBY/
ON
2
按 TUNER 切換至調諧器,然後反覆按該
按鈕選擇 AM 或 FM 波段。
顯示幕顯示調諧器波段和頻率。
3
調諧頻率。
有三種調諧模式—手動模式,自動模式和快速
模式:
27
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
手動調諧:反覆按
改變所顯示的
•
•
TUNE +/–
記憶電臺
您可以保存多達 30個預設電臺,這樣您就無
頻率。
需每次進行手動調諧進入您喜歡的電臺。
自動調諧:按住
直至頻率顯示開
TUNE +/–
始移動,然後鬆開。調諧器將於發現下一
電臺之後停止工作。重複該步驟,搜索其
他電臺。
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
• 快速調諧:按住TUNE +/–直至頻率顯示幕
開始快速移動。一直按住該按鈕直至到達
您所需的頻率。如有必要,請使用手動調
諧方式對頻率進行微調。
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
改善不良的
接收
FM
ENTER
TUNE–
如果以立體聲模式收聽 FM電臺,但接收信號
較弱,則您可以通過切換為單聲道來改善音
質。
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
1
2
調諧至 FM 廣播電臺。
CH
INPUT
VOL
按
。
SYSTEM SETUP
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
使用
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
FM
3
ꢂ/ꢃ
”,然後按
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
。
ENTER
Mode?
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
4
使用 ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下光標)按鈕選擇“FM
Mono”,然後按 ENTER。
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
當調諧器處於單聲道接收模式時,單聲道指示
標誌( )亮起。
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
選擇上方的
返回至自動立體聲模式
FM Auto
﹝收聽立體聲廣播時,立體聲指示標誌( )
亮起﹞。
調諧至
或
廣播電臺。
FM
對於 FM波段,請根據需要選擇單聲道接收或
1
AM
自動立體聲接收。該設置和預設一同保存。
28
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
03
開始使用
按
。
2
3
SYSTEM SETUP
收聽其他播放源
您可以最多將四個外部播放源(電視機,衛
星接收器等)連接至該系統,其中包括一個數
位播放源。請同樣參見第72頁“連接輔助設
備”。
使用 ꢂ/ꢃ(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“St.
Memory?”,然後按 ENTER。
4
需的預設電臺。
ꢀ/ꢁ
使用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇您所
共有30 個預設位置;每個位置可以保存一個
預設電臺。
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
按
保存預設電臺。
ENTER
5
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
• 如果本系統完全和電源斷開,則所保存的
電臺將保留若干天,在此之後您需重新保
存這些電臺。
如果系統尚未開啟,請按
開啟。
1
ꢂ STANDBY/
ON
同時請務必開啟外部播放源(電視機,衛星
接收器等)。
收聽預設電臺
選擇您要收聽的播放源。
2
3
1
2
務必選定 TUNER 功能。
按鈕選擇預設電臺。
• 按TV 選擇 TV 輸入,或者使用LINE(L1/
L2)選擇 LINE 1 ANA,LINE1 DIG 或LINE
2 ANA 輸入。
用
ST +/–
如有必要,請播放外部播放源。
29
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
第 4 章
家庭影院的聲效
使用該系統,您能以立體聲或環繞聲模式盡情
收聽各種模擬或數位播放源。
用環繞聲進行收聽
您能以環繞聲收聽一切立體聲或者多聲道,模
擬或數位的播放源。使用一種杜比Pro Logic
解碼模式的立體聲播放源(SACD和DVD唱碟
除外)可發出環繞聲。
自動聽音模式
自動聽音模式是按操作收聽一切播放源的最
簡單方法,揚聲器的輸出反映了播放源資料的
各聲道狀態。
BASS MODE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
3
SYSTEM
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
SUBTITLE
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
HOME
MENU
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
8
9
3
SYSTEM
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
CLR
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
•
反覆按 SURROUND 選擇聽音模式﹝或按
SURROUND 後使用 ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下光標)按
鈕﹞。
按
選擇 “ ”聽音模式。
Auto
•
AUTO
如果播放源採用了杜比數位或DTS,則顯示幕
上的 指示標誌將亮起。
顯示幕中出現的聽音模式將根據所播放的播
放源類型進行變化。
或
2 DIGITAL
DTS
• Auto
-自動聽音模式(請參見上文)
-杜比數位或DTS解
/
• Dolby Digital DTS
碼(取決於播放源)。對於多聲道播放源,
該模式與
• 當選擇了自動聽音模式時,之前所有開啟
的杜比Pro Logic或高級環繞聲模式將被
取消。
相同。
Auto
-4.1聲道環繞聲用於所有的雙
• Pro Logic
聲道播放源。
-Pro Logic II5.1聲道環繞
• PL II Movie
聲,對於電影播放源尤為適合,並可用於
所有的雙聲道播放源。
30
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
-ProLogic II5.1聲道環繞
• PL II Music
在杜比
音樂模式開啟後,按
Pro Logic II
1
聲,對於音樂播放源尤為適合,並可用於
所有的雙聲道播放源(請參見下文的“杜
比Pro Logic II 音樂設定”)。
。
SOUND
2
用 ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇
“C Width”,“Dimen.”或 “Pnrm.”。
• C Width (中央寬度):使中央聲道更寬
• Stereo -請參見下文“以立體聲模式收
聽”。
(較高設定)或更窄(較低設定)
• Dimen.
(範圍):使聲音更遠(消減設
定)或更前(增加設定)
(全景):創造更廣闊的環繞聲空間
• Pnrm.
有關立體聲和環繞聲播放選項的詳細說
明,請同樣參見第 32 頁“使用高級環繞
聲效果”。
•
用
(上/下光標)按鈕調節設定。
3
ꢀ/ꢁ
中央寬度可在 和 之間進行調節; 範圍可
0
7
在
和
之間進行調節。全景可在
On
或
-3
+3
之間進行切換。
Off
4
按 ENTER 進行確認。
您無法對SACD、DVD唱碟和96kHz PCM音源
使用環繞聲模式。
•
•
當接有耳機時,僅
選項可用。
Stereo
以立體聲模式收聽
您可以立體聲模式收聽一切立體聲或多聲道,
模擬或數位的播放源。當播放多聲道播放源
時,可通過將所有聲道向下混合至前置左/前
置右揚聲器以及超低音揚聲器從而產生立體
聲。
• 當以Dolby Digital / DTS 模式進行收聽
時,雙聲道資料將自動使用杜比Pro Logic
解碼方式以環繞聲進行播放。
• 僅使用中央聲道的杜比數位/DTS播放源
無法以環繞聲進行播放。
BASS MODE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
杜比
音樂設定
Pro Logic II
HOME
MENU
當在杜比Pro Logic II 音樂模式下收聽時,
您可以進一步調節三個參數:中央寬度,範圍
和全景。
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
預設狀態︰
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
3
C Width︰
Dimen.︰
0
•
反覆按 SURROUND 直至顯示幕中出現
Pnrm.︰
Off
“Stereo”。
所有開啟的高級環繞聲模式將被取消。
31
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
使用高級環繞聲效果
高級環繞聲效果可用於多聲道或立體聲播放
源,以獲得各種附加的環繞聲效果。
有關立體聲和環繞聲播放選項的詳細說
明,請同樣參見下文“使用高級環繞聲效
果”。
•
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢅ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
用耳機收聽
當連接了耳機時,只有
DVD MENU
RETURN
(預設)和
Stereo
(耳機虛擬環繞聲)模式
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
Phones Surround
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
有效。
接有耳機時,請按
選擇
•
“
ADVANCED
MASTER
VOLUME
”或 按
選擇
SURROUND
Phones Surround
”。
TV CONTROL
“
Stereo
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
按
選擇高級環繞聲模式﹝或
•
按
ADVANCED
然後用
(上/下光標)
ꢀ/ꢁ
ADVANCED
按鈕﹞。
反覆按該按鈕從以下項目中選擇:
-賦予音樂廳類型的聲音
• Adv. Music
-賦予影院類型的聲音
• Adv. Movie
• Expanded -創造極寬廣的立體聲聲場
• TV Surr. -設計用於單聲道或立體聲電視
廣播和其他播放源
32
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
-設計用於體育節目和其他評論節
• Sports
增強對話
預設狀態:
目
•
Dialog Off
• Game -創造視頻遊戲播放源的環繞聲
對話增強功能設計用於使電視或電影音軌中
的對話聲比其他背景聲更顯著。
• ExPwrSurr.(超強環繞聲)-賦予立體聲
播放源更大的能量與寬度
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
ADVANCED
• Virtual
-僅創造出來自前置揚聲器的環
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
繞聲效果
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
-設計用於對立體聲音樂播放
• 5ch Stereo
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
源帶來強勁的環繞聲
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
• 您無法對SACD、DVD唱碟和96 kHzPCM播放
源使用高級環繞聲模式。
•
反覆按該按鈕從以下項目中選擇:
按 DIALOGUE 選擇對話增強的大小。
•
•
您可以對任何類型的播放源使用上述任何
一種的高級環繞聲模式。給定的說明僅作
參考。
-無對話增強
• Dialog Off
• Dialog Mid
• Dialog Max
-適度的對話增強
-有力的對話增強
當接有耳機時,僅
可用。
選項
Phones Surround
調節高級環繞聲效果等級
•
您可以隨意對高級環繞聲模式的效果進行增
強或減弱。對於各高級環繞聲模式,您可以分
別對效果等級進行設置。
您無法對SACD、DVD唱碟和96 kHz PCM播放
源使用對話增強功能。
在高級環繞聲模式開啟後,按
。
SOUND
1
2
用 ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇
“Effect”。
用
3
級。
(上/下光標)按鈕調節效果等
ꢀ/ꢁ
效果等級可以在 (最小)至 (最大)之
10
90
間進行調節。
按
進行確認。
ENTER
4
33
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
用虛擬後置環繞聲揚聲器收聽
預設狀態:
使用安靜和午夜聽音模式
預設狀態:
Off
•
Vir. SB Off
•
當以環繞聲模式收聽時,可使用虛擬後置環繞
聲功能來模擬附加的後置環繞聲聲道。在真正
的影院裡,後置環繞聲揚聲器應該位於您的正
後方,以創造更多連續而逼真的環繞聲。
安靜收聽功能可降低聲音播放源中過多的低
音或高音。如果音樂有點刺耳但您更喜歡較為
柔滑的聲音,則可以使用該功能。
午夜收聽功能讓您能在低音量級的情況下聽
到電影中實際的環繞聲。該效果自動根據您正
在收聽的音量進行調節。
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SETUP
SUBTITLE
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
8
9
3
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
CLR
4
ROOM SETUP
QUIET/
TIMER/
MAIN
SUB
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
反覆按
將在“
”和
Vir. SB On
•
“
VIRTUAL SB
”之間進行切換。
Vir. SB Off
反覆按
將在“
”,
•
“
QUIET/MIDNIGHT
Quiet
”和 “ ”之間進行切換。
Midnight
Off
當以
或
Stereo Virtual
聽音模式收聽時,您
•
無法使用虛擬後置環繞。
當接有耳機時,您無法使用虛擬後置環繞
聲。
當接有耳機時,在下列情況下,您不能設定
安靜/午夜聽音模式。
•
•
•
如果沒有環繞聲聲道,虛擬後置環繞聲將
不起作用。
裝入SACD或DVD唱碟時。
•
您無法對SACD、DVD唱碟和96 kHz PCM音源
使用虛擬後置環繞聲效果。
34
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
調節低音和高音
增強低音等級
您可以使用三種低音模式來增強播放源中的
預設狀態:高音: ,低音:
0
•
0
低音。
使用低音和高音控制按鈕調節全部音調。當開
啟了安靜或午夜模式後,無法進行低音和高音
調節。
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
ꢃ
ꢋ
ꢄ
ꢀ
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
ꢅ
ꢈ
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
ꢌ
ꢌ
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
DVD MENU
RETURN
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
反覆按
選擇適合您正在收聽
•
的播放源的選項。
BASS MODE
MASTER
VOLUME
-可用於音樂,以帶來較為低沉的
• Music
低音
1
2
SOUND
。
按
用
-適用於動作片或具有許多聲音
• Cinema
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
ꢂ/ꢃ
”
Bass
效果的電影
或 “
”。
Treble
• P. Bass -可用於音樂播放源,以在最前方
產生音樂(或音軌)的節拍聲
• Off
用
(上/下光標)按鈕調節聲音。
3
ꢀ/ꢁ
低音和高音可在-3 到+3 之間進行調節。
4
按 ENTER 進行確認。
您無法對SACD和DVD唱碟使用低音模式。
•
當接有耳機時,在下列情況下,您不能調節
高音/低音。
• 當接有耳機時,您無法使用低音模式。
• 錄音模式設為ON時
裝入SACD或DVD唱碟時
•
35
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
04
家庭影院的聲效
靜音
如果您需要暫時關閉揚聲器中的聲音,請使用
按鈕。
MUTE
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
ST–
ST+
ENTER
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
•
要取消靜音或調節音量,請再次按
MUTE
按
執行靜音。
。
MUTE
36
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
第 5 章
播放碟片
按
,從屏幕提示中選擇
HOME MENU
1
“
介紹
”(碟片導向)。
Disc Navigator
如果裝入的是VR格式的DVD-RW、CD、VCD/
本章介紹的大部分功能都採用了螢幕顯示。關
於如何導向它們的說明請參見第21頁“使用
螢幕顯示”。
超級VCD或MP3/JPEG碟片,您也可以選擇按
按鈕,它使您可直接進入碟片導
DVD MENU
本章介紹的大部分功能都適用於 DVD 碟片和
SACD、VCD/超級VCD、CD和MP3/JPEG碟片,
盡管其中一些實際操作會隨裝入碟片的種類
而略有差異。
向畫面。
HOME MENU
DVD
Play Mode
Video Adjust
某些DVD碟片限制某些功能的使用(例如,隨
機播放或重複播放)。這並非故障。
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
在播放 VCD /超級 VCD 時,某些功能無法在
PBC播放過程中使用。如果您要使用它們,請
通過數字按鈕選擇曲目來開始播放碟片。
選擇您想播放的部分。
2
根據裝入碟片的種類,碟片導向畫面看上去略
有不同。
DVD影碟的畫面在左面顯示標題,右面顯示章。
請選定一個標題或標題中的章。
要進入遙控器上呈綠色顯示的各功能,請
將滑動開關從MAIN 移至SUB。
•
Disc Navigator
Title 1-10
Chapter 1-3
使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片內容
使用碟片導向來瀏覽碟片內容以找到您想播
放的部分。您可以在碟片播放或停止時使用碟
片導向。
DVD
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
對於DVD唱碟,請選擇一個分組或分組內的曲
目。
Disc Navigator
Group 1-3
Track 1-36
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
DVD-Audio
37
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
對於 SACD,請選擇當前播放區域內的一個曲
目。
MP3 碟片的屏幕顯示畫面在左邊顯示文件夾
名,在右邊顯示曲目名(請注意,如果有 16
個以上的文件夾或曲目名稱包含重音符或非
羅馬字符,則曲目和文件夾名將以類屬名顯示
Disc Navigator
Track 1-14
2ch Area
-
,
F_033 T_035
等)。
Track 001
Track 002
Track 003
Track 004
Track 005
選定一個文件夾或文件夾中的曲目。
Track 006
Track 007
Track 008
Disc Navigator
Folder 1-17
Track 1-10
MP3
001. ACP
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
對於VR(視頻錄製)模式的DVD-RW碟片,
請在碟片或標題的
004. Live
(播放列表)和
Playlist
(原始)區域中選擇一個,或選擇
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
007.Thermo
008. Missing Man
Original
一個標題。按
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
(右光標)預覽標題。
ꢃ
在播放過程中無法在
(原始)和
•
Original
(播放列表)之間進行切換。
播放將在按動
後開始。
ENTER
Playlist
並非所有VR格式的DVD-RW碟片都具有
Playlist(播放列表)。
•
碟片導向功能只有在碟片裝入後才能使
用。
•
•
Disc Navigator
Title(1-3)
DVD-RW
Original
01. 3/31 FIRST LEAGUE
02. 4/28 SECOND LEAGUE
03. 4/29 FINAL ROUND
如果以PBC模式播放VCD/超級VCD,或者播
放的是一張未最終完成的 CD-R/RW 碟片,
碟片導向功能將無法使用。
Play List
查找碟片特定位置的另一方法是使用搜索
模式中的一種。請參見第 47 頁“搜索碟
片”。
•
CD 和VCD/超級 VCD 的畫面顯示曲目列表。
(以下畫面以CD為例)
Disc Navigator
Track 1-10
掃描碟片
您可以使用各種不同的速度向前或向後快速
CD
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
掃描碟片。
在碟片播放時,按
或
開始掃描。
1
2
ꢅ
ꢈ
反覆按以加快掃描速度。
• MP3曲目只能用一種速度掃描。
掃描速度將螢幕顯示。
•
38
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
按
(播放)恢復正常播放。
按
(播放)恢復正常播放。
3
ꢄ
4
ꢄ
在掃描CD唱碟、SACD和MP3碟片時您能聽見
聲音。
VCD/超級VCD僅支持前進的慢動作播放。
•
•
•
•
慢動作播放的畫面質量沒有正常播放的
好。
當掃描VCD/超級VCD或MP3的某個曲目時,
播放將自動在該曲目的起點或終點處開
始。
根據碟片類型,在到達新的章時可能自動
恢復正常播放。
•
掃描DVD影碟和VCD/超級VCD時,沒有聲音
•
輸出。掃描DVD影碟時沒有字幕顯示。
逐幀前進/逐幀倒退
• 根據碟片類型,在到達DVD影碟上某個新的
章時可能自動恢復正常播放。
您可以逐幀前進或倒退播放 DVD影碟或VR格
式的 DVD-RW碟片。對於 VCD/超級 VCD,您
僅能使用逐幀前進播放。
慢動作播放
1
ꢁ)。
在碟片播放時按 ꢋ (暫停)(上面板上的
您能夠以四種不同的慢速播放DVD影碟、DVD-
R/RW和VCD/超級VCD。DVD影碟和DVD-R/RW
還能以兩種慢速倒退播放。
按
按
或
ꢆ/ꢇ ꢉ/ꢊ
每次倒退或前進一幀。
2
3
(播放)(上面板上的
)恢復正
ꢁ
ꢄ
1
2
播放時,按 ꢋ(暫停)(上面板上的 ꢁ)。
按住 直到慢動作播放開
常播放。
或
ꢆ/ꢇ
ꢉ/ꢊ
始。
慢動作播放速度螢幕顯示。
慢動作播放時沒有聲音輸出。
•
•
使用逐幀倒退時的畫面質量沒有逐幀前進
的好。
•
•
•
3
反覆按該按鈕改變慢速播放的速度。
根據碟片類型,到達新的章節時可能自動
恢復正常播放。
• 慢速播放的速度螢幕顯示。
對於DVD碟片,在改變播放方向時,畫面會
以無法預期的方式“移動”。這並非故障。
39
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
在 “
(
)”( (終點))處
4
按
B
End Point
,以設定循環終點。
B
循環播放碟片上的某一段
ENTER
A-B重複功能讓您能夠指定曲目(CD和VCD)
或標題(DVD 影碟或DVD-RW)中的兩個點(A
和B),以形成反覆播放的循環段。
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
對於MP3碟片、DVD唱碟、SACD、超級VCD、
PBC模式下的VCD或未最終完成的CD-R/RW
碟片,您不能使用A-B重複功能。
•
在您按
按鈕後,播放跳回到起點開始
ENTER
循環播放。
最小循環時間為2秒鐘。
在碟片播放時,按
選擇
1
“
HOME MENU
•
”(播放模式)。
Play Mode
要恢復正常播放,請在選單中選擇“
5
(關閉)。
”
Off
2
從左邊功能列表中選擇 “A-B Repeat”
(重複播放)。
Play Mode
使用重複播放
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
重複播放的選項隨裝入碟片的類型而異,您也
可以與編序播放一起使用重複播放,以重複播
放編序列表中的曲目/章(請參見第 43 頁
“創建編序列表”)。
Random
Program
Search Mode
在 “
(
)”( (起點))處
Start Point
3
按
A
A
,以設定循環起點。
ENTER
對於PBC模式下的VCD/超級VCD或未最終
完成的CD-R/RW碟片,您無法使用重複播
放。
•
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
A(Start Point)
B(End Point)
Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
40
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
對於 SACD、CD和VCD/超級VCD,選擇
Disc
(曲目
Track Repeat
使用
OSD
(碟片重複)或
Repeat
重複)〔或者
1
在碟片播放時,按 HOME MENU 選擇
(重複播放關閉)〕。
Repeat Off
“Play Mode”(播放模式)。
Play Mode
2
Repeat
從左邊的功能列表中選擇“ ”(重
複播放)。
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Disc Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Play Mode
Program
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Repeat
Chapter Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Program
對於 MP3 碟片,選擇
(碟片重
Disc Repeat
Search Mode
複)、
(文件夾重複)或
Folder Repeat
Track
(重
Repeat Off
(曲目重複)〔或者
Repeat
3
選擇重複播放選項。
複播放關閉)〕。
如果編序播放已激活,請選擇Program
Repeat (編序重複)以重複播放編序列表,
或選擇Repeat Off (重複播放關閉)以取消
重複播放。
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Disc Repeat
Folder Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Program
Title Repeat
對於DVD影碟或DVD-RW碟片,選擇
Search Mode
Chapter Repeat
(標題重複)或
〔或者
(章重複)
Repeat Off
(重複播放關閉)〕。
Play Mode
使用顯示幕
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Repeat
碟片播放時,按
•
放選項。
選擇一個重複播
REPEAT
Chapter Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
Program
反覆按直到您所要的重複播放選項顯示在顯
示幕上。
Search Mode
重複播放選項與OSD中的選項(參見上文)相
同。
對於DVD唱碟,選擇
(分組
Group Repeat
重複)或
(曲目重複)〔或者
Track Repeat
(重複播放關閉)〕。
Repeat Off
Play Mode
如果您已創建了一個編序列表,也可使用
Program Repeat。
•
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Group Repeat
Track Repeat
Repeat Off
Random
• 在播放期間,您可以按CLR取消重複播放。
Program
Search Mode
41
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
選擇隨機播放選項。
對於DVD影碟,請選擇
3
(隨機
Random Title
播放標題)或
(隨機播放
Random Chapter
(隨機播放關閉)〕。
您不能同時使用重複和隨機播放。
•
•
章)〔或
Random Off
如果您在重複播放過程中切換了視角,重
複播放將被取消。
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Random Title
Repeat
Random Chapter
Random Off
使用隨機播放
Random
您可使用隨機播放功能以隨機順序播放標題
或章(DVD 影碟)、分組或曲目 (DVD 唱碟)
或曲目(SACD、CD、VCD/超級VCD和MP3碟片)。
Program
Search Mode
您可以在碟片正在播放或被停止播放時設定
隨機播放選項。
對於DVD唱碟,請選擇
(隨
Random Group
機播放分組)或
(隨機播放
Random Track
曲目)〔或
(隨機播放關閉)〕。
Random Off
Play Mode
對於VR格式的DVD-RW碟片、PBC模式下播放
的VCD/超級VCD或者當DVD碟片選單正
在顯示時,您不能使用隨機播放。
•
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random Group
Random Track
Random Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
OSD
使用
對於 CD和 VCD/超級 VCD,請選擇 On (打
在碟片播放時,按
選擇
1
“
HOME MENU
開)或Off(關閉)以打開或關閉隨機播放。
”(播放模式)。
Play Mode
2
從左 邊的 功能 列表中 選擇 “Random”
(隨機播放)。
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
On
Off
Random
Play Mode
Program
Search Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random Title
Random Chapter
Random Off
Random
Program
Search Mode
42
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
對於MP3碟片,請選擇
(隨機播
Random All
放全部)(所有文件夾)或
(隨
Random Track
機播放曲目)(僅限於當前文件夾)〔或
(隨機播放關閉)〕。
對於VR格式的DVD-RW碟片、PBC模式下播放
的VCD/超級VCD,或者當DVD碟片選單
正在顯示時,您不能使用編序播放功能。
•
Random Off
Play Mode
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Random All
Random Track
Random Off
OSD
使用
Random
Program
在碟片播放時,按
選擇
1
“
HOME MENU
Search Mode
”(播放模式)。
Play Mode
2 從 左邊的 功能列 表中選 擇 “Program”
(編序播放)。
Play Mode
• 您也可以使用遙控器上的RANDOM 按鈕
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Create/Edit
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
來選擇隨機播放模式。隨機播放模式將在
顯示幕和在屏畫面上顯示。可用的隨機播
放模式與Play Mode 選擇。按ENTER 選
Random
Program
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
單中可選擇的相同。
• 要停止碟片並取消隨機播放,請按ꢀ(停
止)。
從編序選項的列表中選擇“
3
(創建/編輯)。
”
Create/Edit
• 要取消隨機播放功能而不停止播放,請按
Play Mode
CLR
按鈕。碟片將播放至結尾,然後停止。
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Create/Edit
在隨機播放時,
和
按鈕功能與正常
ꢍ
•
ꢌ
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
狀態下略有不同︰
返回到當前曲目/
Random
ꢌ
Program
章的開始處。您無法再進一步返回。
ꢍ
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
從其餘部分中隨機選取其他曲目/章。
您無法與編序播放或重複播放一起使用隨
機播放功能。
•
所顯示的編序編輯畫面根據裝入碟片的種類
而異。
畫面左邊是編序列表,右邊是標題列表(如
果裝入的是DVD影碟)、分組列表(如果裝入
的是DVD唱碟)、曲目(對於SACD、CD和VCD
/超級VCD)或者是文件夾列表(對於MP3碟
片)。最右邊是章(對於DVD影碟)或曲目名
稱(對於MP3)的列表。
創建編序列表
本功能讓您能夠編製碟片上標題/組/章/
文件夾/曲目的播放順序。
43
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
在編序列表中為當前步驟選擇一個標題、
4
章、分組、文件夾或曲目。
要添加曲目,請先高亮顯示分組,然後按
•
(右光標)並從列表中選擇一個曲目。
ꢃ
對於DVD影碟,您可以將整個標題或標題內的
章添加至編序列表。
Program
Program Step
Group 1-38
Track 1-4
01. 01-003
02.
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
Group 04
Group 05
Group 06
Group 07
Group 08
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
要添加標題,請選擇該標題。
•
03.
04.
Program
05.
06.
Program Step
Title 1~38
Chapter 1~4
07.
01. 01
02.
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Chapter 004
08.
03.
04.
05.
對於 SACD、CD 或VCD /超級VCD,選擇一個
06.
07.
曲目以添加到編序列表中。
08.
Program
Program Step
Track 1~12
要添加章,先高亮顯示其所在標題,然後
•
01. 04
02.
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
Track 05
Track 06
Track 07
Track 08
按 (右光標)並從列表中選擇一個章。
ꢃ
03.
04.
Program
05.
06.
Program Step
Title 1-38
Chapter 1-4
07.
01. 01-003
02.
Title 01
Title 02
Title 03
Title 04
Title 05
Title 06
Title 07
Title 08
Chapter 001
Chapter 002
Chapter 003
Chapter 004
08.
03.
04.
05.
對於MP3碟片,您可以將整個文件夾或文件夾
內的曲目添加至編序列表中。
06.
07.
08.
• 要添加文件夾,請選擇該文件夾。
對於DVD唱碟,您可以將整個分組或分組內的
曲目添加至編序列表。
Program
Program Step
Folder 1-6
Track 1-10
01. 001
02.
001. ACP
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
要添加分組,請選擇該分組。
•
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
03.
04.
004. Live
Program
05.
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
06.
Program Step
Group 1~38
Track 1~4
07.
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
01. 01
02.
Group 01
Group 02
Group 03
Group 04
Group 05
Group 06
Group 07
Group 08
Track 01
Track 02
Track 03
Track 04
08.
03.
04.
05.
06.
07.
08.
44
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
要添加一個曲目,先找到其文件夾,然後
播放時,按
選擇 “
HOME MENU Play
•
1
按
(右光標)並從列表中選擇一個曲
”。
Mode
ꢃ
目名稱。
2 從左邊功能列表中選定 “Program”(編
序)。
Program
Program Step
Folder 1-6
Track 1-10
3
(創建/編輯)。
Create/Edit
”
從編 序選項列表中 選定 “
01. 001-003
001. ACP
001. Gravity deluxe
002.Tesla's patent
003. Border dispute
004. Delayed by rain
005. Accident incident
006. Pigeon post
02.
03.
04.
05.
06.
07.
08.
002. Nth Degree
003. Pfeuti
004. Live
005. Glitch music
006. CodHead
要清除一個步驟,請高亮顯示該步驟號並
4
按
007. Outernational
008. Vacuum tube
。
CLR
5
要在編序列表中插入一個步驟,請高亮打
按
選擇標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲
ENTER
算讓新步驟出現在該處的步號,再選定一個要
加入的標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲目。
按ENTER 後,新的步驟被插入列表。
目後,步驟號將自動向下移動一步。
重複步驟 ,以建立編序列表。
4
5
6
一個編序列表最多可以包含24 個標題/章/
分組/文件夾/曲目。
要在編序列表末尾增加一個步驟,請高亮
顯示新步驟要插入位置的步驟,再選定一個要
增加的標題/章/分組/文件夾/曲目。
6
要按編序列表播放,按 ꢄ (播放)按鈕。
編序播放將保持激活狀態,直到您關閉編序播
放(參見下文)、刪除編序列表(參見下文)、
退出碟片或關閉播放機或切換到DVD (CD)以
• 要保存編序列表,退出編序列表編輯畫面
外的其他功能。
HOME MENU
而不開始播放,請按
。
如果您想不保存所作的修改並退出編序列
表編輯畫面,請按
•
。
RETURN
要保存您的編序列表並退出編序編輯畫面
但不開始播放,請按HOME MENU。(請
勿按 RETURN -這樣做不能保存編序列
•
OSD 編序選單的其他功能
通過播放模式選單,您除了能創建和編輯編序
列表,還能夠開始編序播放,取消編序播放,
刪除編序列表和記憶編序列表。
表)。
• 編序播放時,按ꢍ 將跳至編序列表中的
下一步。
播放時按
可關閉編序播放。播放停止
•
CLR
時按該按鈕可刪除編序列表。
使用 OSD 編輯編序列表
在編序列表創建後,您可以增加,刪除或改變
其中的步驟。
45
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
按
選擇 “ ”。
Play Mode
1
2
HOME MENU
使用本機顯示幕
儘管 OSD適用於SACD,CD和MP3碟片,但顯
示幕仍提供了充足資訊以方便地創建編序列
表。如果正在播放一張碟片,請先停止播放。
從左邊功能列表中選定 “Program”(編
序)。
Play Mode
1
按 PROGRAM。
A-B Repeat
Create/Edit
提示您在編序列表中首先輸入一首曲目或文
件夾。
Repeat
Playback Start
Playback Stop
Program Delete
Program Memory
Random
Program
Search Mode
ꢄ Off
P - 0 0
0 0 0
用
2
目,按
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇一首曲
ꢀ/ꢁ
選定編序播放功能。
3
。
ENTER
(創建/編輯)-請參見前
• Create/Edit
述內容
P - 0 1
5 3 7
(開始播放)-開始播放
• Playback Start
已保存的編序列表
• 僅限 MP3碟片:要選擇文件夾中的單個曲
目,請用 ꢀ/ꢁ (上/下光標)按鈕選擇
文件夾後,按ꢃ,然後用ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下
光標)按鈕選擇一首曲目。按ENTER。
• Playback Stop (停止播放)-關閉編序
播放,但不刪除編序列表
• Program Delete
序列表並關閉編序播放
(刪除編序)-刪除編
在完成各種選擇之後,等待顯示幕對您的提
CLR
示。如果您未正確操作,請按
一首(最近一首)編序曲目。
刪除最後
(編序記憶)(僅對於
• Program Memory
DVD影碟)-選定On以保存所裝入碟片的
重複步驟 創建編序列表。
3
一個編序列表可包含多達24首曲目。
2
編序列表。(選定
的編序記憶)
則取消所裝入碟片
Off
要播放編序列表,請按 (播放)。
ꢄ
4
編序播放將保持開啟直至您按下 (停止),
ꢀ
清除播放列表(請參見下文),彈出碟片或關
閉播放機為止。
• 可對裝入的DVD碟片保存編序列表。當您裝
入一張保存有編序列表的碟片時,編序播
放將自動開啟。
清除編序列表
要編製新的編序列表,您必須清除原有編序列
您可以保存多達24張碟片的編序列表。此
後,最早保存的播放列表將被最新保存的
播放列表取代。
•
表。
1
2
如果正在播放一張碟片,請按 ꢀ(停止)。
按
。
CLR
46
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
某些DVD唱碟具有可瀏覽圖片的頁面。請輸
入您要的頁碼。
•
•
搜索碟片
您可以通過標題或章號碼或通過時間對DVD影
碟碟片進行搜索。對DVD唱碟可分組或按曲目
或按頁碼進行搜索,對 SACD,CD /超級 VCD
可以通過曲目號進行搜索,對VCD可通過曲目
號或時間進行搜索,對MP3碟片則可以通過文
件夾或曲目號進行搜索。
5
按 ENTER 開始播放。
您僅能對DVD影碟和VCD碟片使用時間搜索
功能。
1
在播放過程中,按 HOME MENU 選擇
• 要使用時間搜索功能,碟片必須正在播放。
“Play Mode”。
•
對於PBC模式下的VCD/超級VCD或未最終
2
(搜索模式)。
Search Mode
”
從左邊功能列表中選定“
完成的CD-R/RW碟片,搜索功能不可用。
•
顯示的搜索選項根據裝入碟片的類型而異。以
下畫面顯示了DVD影碟搜索選項。
對於兩張以上的SACD碟片,在第二張碟片
過後,您可能無法選擇碟片的首個曲目。
Play Mode
播放
唱碟的 “附送類”
DVD
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Search
某些DVD唱碟具有額外的附送類,這些分組需
要4位數的密碼才能獲取。詳情和有關密碼,
請參見碟片包裝。當您嘗試播放附送類,本播
放機將自動提示您輸入密碼。
Chapter Search
Time Search
Random
Program
Search Mode
使用數字按鈕輸入 位數密碼。
4
也可以通過選項選單輸入密碼。請參見第
69頁。
1
3
4
選定一個搜索模式。
•
用數字按鈕輸入標題、組、章、文件夾或
曲目號,或者是時間或頁碼。
切換字幕
Play Mode
某些DVD影碟具有一種或多種語言的字幕,碟
片包裝盒一般會告知有哪些字幕語言可以使
用。您能夠在碟片播放時切換字幕語言。
A-B Repeat
Repeat
Title Search
Input Chapter
Chapter Search
Time Search
0
0
1
Random
Program
Search Mode
反覆按
選定一個字幕選項。
SUBTITLE
•
Current / Total
Subtitle 1/2
English
• 對時間搜索,請將您希望碟片播放恢復位
置的分鐘和秒數輸入到當前正在播放的標
題(DVD 影碟/DVD-RW)或曲目(VCD)中。
例如,按 4、5、0、0 讓播放從碟片上的
有些碟片只允許您從碟片選單來改變字幕
語言。按TOP MENU 可進入碟片選單。
•
45分鐘處起開始。對 1小時20 分30秒,
請按8、0、3、0。
47
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
要設置字幕首選項,請參見第65頁
•
切換 VCD /超級 VCD 的音頻
聲道
當播放VCD/超級VCD時,您可以在立體聲、
“Subtitle Language(字幕語言)”。
僅左聲道或僅右聲道之間進行切換。
切換 影碟伴音語言
在播放錄有兩種以上語言對白的DVD影碟時,
DVD
•
反覆按 AUDIO 選擇一個音頻聲道選項。
您能夠在播放中切換伴音語言。
反覆按
選定一個伴音語言選項。
Audio
Stereo
•
AUDIO
Current /Total
1/2
Audio
French
Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH
放大屏幕畫面
在欣賞DVD影碟,DVD 唱碟或VCD/超級VCD
時,您能夠利用放大功能將畫面的一部分放大
2 倍或4倍。
• 有些碟片只允許您從碟片選單來改變音頻
語言。按TOP MENU 可進入碟片選單。
在播放中用
按鈕選擇放大倍數。
1
ZOOM
(正常)
• Normal
• 2x
•
要設置伴音語言首選項,請參見第 65 頁
“Audio Language(伴音語言)”。
• 4x
DVD
根據碟片類型,播放DVD唱碟時您可以切換聲
切換
唱碟的音頻聲道
道-詳情請參見碟片盒。
反覆按
選擇一個音頻聲道選項。
1
AUDIO
Zoom 2x
Digital Out Converted
Linear PCM 192kHz24bit
2CH
Audio
1
當您改變音頻聲道時,播放將自當前曲目的起
始處重新開始。
Zoom 4x
某些碟片僅容許您通過碟片選單改變音頻
聲道。請按
•
•
可進入碟片選單。
TOP MENU
• 由於DVD影碟,DVD唱碟或VCD/超級VCD的
分辨率是固定的,因此圖像質量會有所下
降,尤其是以4倍放大時。但這不是故障。
要設置伴音語言首選項,請參見第 65 頁
“Audio Language(伴音語言)”。
48
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
用光標按鈕改變放大區域。
DVD影碟顯示
2
•
您可以在播放過程中隨意地改變放大倍數和
放大區域。
Play
DVD
ꢄ
Current / Total Elapsed
11/38 2.05
Remain
4.57
Total
7.02
Title
French
Audio Dolby Digital 3/2.1CH
English
Subtitle
1
如果屏幕頂部的導向方框消失,請再按
ZOOM 使其顯示。
•
Angle
Play
DVD
ꢄ
Current / Total Elapsed
11/38 2.05
Remain
4.57
Total
7.02
Chapter
Tr. Rate
8.6Mbps
當屏幕畫面被放大時,我們建議不要使用
DVD 碟片選單,因為此時選單選項將無法
高亮顯示。
•
•
• DVD唱碟顯示
Play
DVD-Audio
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/14
Elapsed
3.20
Remain
2.41
Total
6.01
Track
Audio
如果您顯示了字幕,當屏幕畫面被放大時
它們會消失。當屏幕畫面回到正常大小時
它們會再次出現。
- -
1
1
Linear PCM
Subtitle
Angle
192kHz 24bit 2/0CH
-Audio
DVD
Play
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/3
Elapsed
3.21
Remain
53.20
Total
56.41
Group
Tr. Rate
:
9.5Mbps
切換視角
某些DVD影碟具有以兩個以上角度拍攝的畫面
VR格式DVD-RW顯示
•
-詳情請參閱碟片包裝盒。
Play
Title
DVD-RW
Original
Elapsed
0.08
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/32
Remain
30.22
Total
30.30
當多視角畫面被播放時,屏幕上會出現一個
圖標,以讓您知道還可觀看其他角度的
畫面〔如果您愿意,也可關閉這項功能-請
參見第67 頁“Angle Indicator(角度指示
器)”〕。
1
- -
Audio Dolby Digital
2/0CH
Subtitle
Play
DVD-RW
Original
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/1
Chapter
Tr. Rate
4.3Mbps
•
在碟片播放(或暫停)時,按 ANGLE 切換
視角。
SACD顯示
•
Play
Track
SACD
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/14
Elapsed
0.13
Remain
4.21
Total
4.34
顯示碟片資訊
在播放DVD碟片時,屏幕上可顯示碟片的各種
(僅在多聲道播放過程中)
曲目,章和標題資訊以及視頻傳輸率。
Play
SACD
Elapsed
0.22
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/9
Remain
3.38
Total
4.00
Track
3/2.1CH
碟片資訊
OSD
Audio
•
要顯示/切換所顯示的資訊,請按
Play
Disc
SACD
ꢄ
Elapsed
0.05
Remain
73.00
Total
73.05
DISPLAY。
在碟片被播放時,資訊出現在屏幕頂部。按住
以改變顯示的資訊。
DISPLAY
49
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
CD和VCD顯示
•
Play
CD
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/16
Elapsed
1.07
Remain
4.40
Total
5.47
Track
Play
Disc
CD
ꢄ
Elapsed
28.00
Remain
30.20
Total
58.20
(僅在PBC播放過程中)
•
•
Play
VCD
ꢄ
超級VCD顯示
Play
CD
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/16
Elapsed
1.07
Track
• MP3碟片顯示
Play
MP3
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/17
Elapsed
0.18
Remain
12.42
Total
13.00
Track
Track Name
Outernational
Play
MP3
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/7
Folder
Folder Name ACP
JPEG碟片顯示
•
Play
JPEG
ꢄ
Current / Total
1/40
File
File Name
FL000001
Play
JPEG
ꢄ
Current / Total
2/6
Folder
Folder Name Holiday
• 您能夠從碟片導向畫面中看到碟片資訊
(標題/章、曲目、組、文件夾等的數目)。
請參見第 37 頁“使用碟片導向瀏覽碟片
內容”。
50
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
05
播放碟片
顯示幕資訊
有限的碟片資訊也出現在前面板顯示幕中。按
改變顯示的資訊。
•
VCD顯示
曲目號
已播放碟片時間
4
11 1 6
DISPLAY
• DVD影碟/DVD-RW顯示
剩餘碟片時間
5 3 1 5
3 2 0
Disc
4
標題號
章號
已播放標題時間
2
2
8 4 9
曲目號
剩餘曲目時間
• 超級VCD顯示
標題號
剩餘標題時間
2
2
TTL 1 0 7 0 0
曲目號
已播放曲目時間
4
1 1 6
標題號
章號
剩餘章時間
2
0 4 2
MP3碟片顯示
•
曲目號
已播放曲目時間
2
0 3 5
DVD唱碟
•
曲目名稱
組號
曲目號
已播放曲目時間
E V E R Y B O D
B E S T _ O F _
2
2
2
2
8 4 9
3 1 5
文件夾名稱
組號
曲目號
剩餘曲目時間
2
JPEG碟片顯示
•
文件名稱
T I G E R _ 0 1
組號
剩餘組時間
GRP 1 4 7 0 0
文件夾名稱
Z O O _ T R I P
SACD/CD顯示
•
曲目號
已播放曲目時間
4
4
1 1 6
曲目號
剩餘曲目時間
3 2 0
剩餘碟片時間
5 3 1 5
Disc
51
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
06
觀看
碟片
JPEG
第 6 章
JPEG
觀看
碟片
播放
碟片
JPEG
裝入含有JPEG圖片的CD/CD-R/RW後,按 從
ꢄ
•
•
•
Loading
按鈕不起作用。
ZOOM
ꢋ
當畫面顯示
和
(正在裝載)時, 、
碟片的第一個文件夾/第一張圖片開始逐張
演示。播放機以字母順序顯示各文件夾中的圖
片。
ANGLE
播放機載入一個文件的時間隨文件尺寸的
增加而增加。
播放機會自動調節圖片尺寸以盡可能使圖片
充滿整個屏幕(如果圖片的縱橫比與您的電
視機屏幕不同,您會發現屏幕左右或上下有黑
條)。
一張碟片上最多可有999個文件供觀看。如
果碟片上的文件數超過這個數目,則只有
前999個文件可以觀看。
逐張放映時︰
使用 JPEG 碟片導向和圖片瀏覽
按鈕
功能
器
ꢋ
暫停逐張放映,再按一次重新開
始。
要通過文件名在處於播放位置的碟片上找到
一個特定文件夾或圖片,請使用 JPEG 碟片導
向;要通過縮略圖在文件夾中找到一張圖片,
請使用圖片瀏覽器。
ꢌ
顯示上一張圖片。
ꢍ
顯示下一張圖片。
ANGLE
暫停逐張放映,並將當前顯示的
ꢄ
按
顯示碟片導向 (
Disc
)畫面。
1
DVD MENU
圖片順時針方向旋轉90°。按
(播放)重新開始逐張放映。
Navigator
Disc Navigator
ZOOM
暫停逐張放映,放大畫面 (請參
ꢄ
Folder 1-2
File 1-40
001. FL000001
002. FL000002
003. FL000003
004. FL000004
005. FL000005
006. FL000006
007. FL000007
008. FL000008
見下文)。按
始逐張放映。
(播放)重新開
JPEG
001. F_001
002. F_002
DVD
MENU
顯示碟片導向畫面(請參見下
文)。
FOLDER +/
FOLDER –
播放JPEG碟片時跳至下一/前一
文件夾。
左列顯示碟片上的文件夾,右列顯示文件夾中
的文件。
用光標按鈕 (
)進行導向。
ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ
當一個文件被高亮顯示時,該文件的縮略圖將
2
顯示。
52
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
06
觀看
碟片
JPEG
當一個文件夾被高亮顯示時,您可以按
為該文件夾打開圖片瀏覽器畫面。
在逐張放映播放時用
1
大倍數。
按鈕選擇放
ZOOM
•
ENTER
關於圖片瀏覽器使用的更多資訊,請參見
下文。
(正常)
• Normal
• 2x
• 4x
3
要從高亮顯示的 文件恢復逐張放映,按
ENTER。
使用圖片瀏覽器
圖片瀏覽器從當前文件夾中一次顯示9張縮略
圖。
1
件夾目錄,然後按
在碟片導向畫面中,高亮一個要顯示的文
ENTER
。
圖片瀏覽器畫面打開,前9 張圖片以縮略圖顯
示。
Photo Browser
2 / 40 Live at Soft
當屏幕畫面被放大時,逐張放映暫停。
•
•
由於JPEG圖片的分辨率是固定的,圖像質
量會有所下降,尤其是以4倍放大時。但
這不是故障。
2
用光標按鈕(ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ)高亮顯示一幅
縮略圖。
• 用曲目跳躍按鈕(ꢌ 和ꢍ)觀看上一
頁/下一頁的縮略圖。如果您想跳過若干
頁,請按住按鈕不放直到您需要的那頁出
現後再鬆開。
用光標 按鈕 (
)改變放 大區
ꢀ/ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ
2
域。
您可以隨意改變放大倍數和放大區域。
3
要恢復逐張放映,按 ꢄ (播放)按鈕。
要回到碟片導向畫面,按
。
•
RETURN
要以全尺寸在屏幕上顯示選定的縮略圖,
3
按
。
ENTER
從所選圖片恢復逐張放映。
放大屏幕畫面
當觀看JPEG 碟片的圖片時,您能夠利用放大
功能將畫面的一部分放大2 倍或4倍。
53
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
07
使用定時器
第 7 章
使用定時器
選擇您要播放的播放源。
例如:按 選擇收音機作為您的播放源。
1
設置喚醒定時器
使用喚醒定時器設置系統以在任何時候開啟
TUNER
電源並開始播放所需的播放源。
準備播放源。
2
例如:調諧喚醒時您所需的廣播電臺。
3
4
設置音量。
按兩次
•
要使喚醒定時器正常工作,必須對時鐘進
行準確的時間設置(請參見第19頁“設
置時鐘”)。
進入定時器選單。
TIMER/CLOCK
用
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
Wake-
5
ꢂ/ꢃ
”,然後按
。
ENTER
Up?
STANDBY/ON
6
用 ꢂ/ꢃ(左/右光標)按鈕選擇
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
“TimerEdit?”,然後按 ENTER。
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
設置開啟時間。
7
ꢃ
ꢋ
用
按
(上/下光標)按鈕設置小時,然後
。以同樣的方式設置分鐘,當您完
ꢀ/ꢁ
ENTER
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
成設置後,按
。
ENTER
DVD MENU
RETURN
TUNE+
設置關閉時間。
(上/下光標)按鈕設置小時,然後
8
用
ST–
ST+
ENTER
ꢀ/ꢁ
TUNE–
MUTE
SOUND
按 ENTER。以同樣的方式設置分鐘,當您完
成設置後,按ENTER。
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
在最後一次按下 ENTER 之後,喚醒指示器亮
起,顯示幕中對開啟,關閉時間,功能(DVD/
CD 等)以及音量進行了確認。
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
將系統切換至待機模式。
9
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
如果系統保持開啟,則喚醒定時器將不起作
用!
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
54
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
07
使用定時器
您可以通過按兩次
在待機
TIMER/CLOCK
•
狀態中檢查定時器設置。(按一次
TIMER/
將顯示當前時間。)
CLOCK
開啟/關閉喚醒定時器
如果喚醒定時器處於開啟狀態,它將每天在您
所設置的時刻開啟系統。
按兩次
進入定時器選單。
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK
用ꢂ/ꢃ(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“Wake-
Up?”,然後按 ENTER。
3
ꢂ/ꢃ
Timer
用
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
On?
Timer Off?
”或 “
”。
您必須對定時器進行設置(請參見上文)
ON
•
以選擇
。喚醒定時器將按照您先前的
設置執行開啟或關閉操作。
按
。
ENTER
4
•
如果時鐘被復位,喚醒定時器將自動取消。
55
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
07
使用定時器
按兩次
進入定時器選單。
1
2
TIMER/CLOCK
設置睡眠定時器
在規定時間後,睡眠定時器將關閉系統,這樣
用 ꢂ/ꢃ(左/右光標)按鈕選擇
“Sleep?”,然後按 ENTER。
您就無需擔心系統而安心入睡。
3
間,然後按
ꢀ/ꢁ
用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇關閉時
ENTER
。
在以下選項之間進行選擇:
如果您在喚醒定時器開啟狀態下設置睡眠
定時器,則較早的關閉時刻優先進行。
•
-在當前 SACD、CD、VCD/超
• Sleep Auto
級VCD或MP3碟片播放完畢之後,系統自
動關閉。
STANDBY/ON
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
-系統在90分鐘之後關閉。
• Sleep 90
DVD
TV
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
• Sleep 60 -系統在1 小時之後關閉。
ꢃ
ꢋ
• Sleep 30 -系統在30分鐘之後關閉。
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
• Sleep Off
-取消睡眠定時器。
DVD MENU
RETURN
要檢查剩餘時間長度,請重複步驟 和 。
1
4
將暫時顯示剩餘時間。
2
ENTER
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
在VCD/超級VCD進行PBC播放
• Sleep Auto
TV CONTROL
期間,或者在CD重複播放期間不起作用。
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
56
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
08
環繞聲設定
第 8 章
環繞聲設定
設定環繞聲
房間設定功能(第20頁)設計用於帶給您一
個基本的環繞聲設定,但是您仍可以進行更詳
細的設置,以改善您收聽房間內的環繞聲。
•
當您改變揚聲器距離和聲道音壓設定時,
這些設定將覆蓋您在房間設定中所作的設
定。
STANDBY/ON
按
。
1
2
SYSTEM SETUP
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
用 ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇您要進
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
行調節的設置。
ꢋ
當您瀏覽顯示幕時,將顯示各選項的當前設
置。請參見下文的各設置的完整列表和說明。
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
用
(上/下光標)按鈕調節設置。
3
4
5
ꢀ/ꢁ
重複步驟
和
進行其它設置。
2
3
ENTER
MUTE
SOUND
當您完成設置後,請按 ENTER 離開系統設
定選單。
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
CH
INPUT
VOL
如果在5分鐘之內不進行操作,系統設置選
•
BASS MODE DIALOGUE
VIRTUAL SB
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
單將自動退出。
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
3
系統設定選單選項
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
4
以下是設定選單中的所有可選設置。各部分的
第一個設置為預設狀態。有關設置的附加資
訊,請同樣參見各章節中的注意事項。
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
57
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
08
環繞聲設定
前置揚聲器距離設置
指定從您的收聽位置到前置揚聲器的距離:
雙重單聲道設置
對以雙重單聲道編碼的杜比數位或DTS音軌指
定播放方式。 您還可以使用該設置對錄有二
個獨立音軌的DVD-RW碟片進行聲道的切換。
• Front 0.3 m ∼ Front 9 m-可以0.3 m為
增量進行距離設置。預設狀態為3 m。
• L-Ch1 R-Ch2 -兩個聲道均通過前置揚聲
器進行播放
中置揚聲器距離設置
指定從您的收聽位置到中置揚聲器的距離:
• Ch1 Mono -僅播放聲道1
• Center 0.3 m
Center 9 m
-可以0.3 m
∼
• Ch2 Mono
-僅播放聲道2
為增量進行距離設置。預設狀態為3 m。
環繞聲揚聲器距離設置
指定從您的收聽位置到前置揚聲器的距離:
• 在 Ch1 Mono 和Ch2 Mono 設置中,聲音
僅從中置揚聲器中傳出(如果以STEREO
模式收聽,則從前置揚聲器中傳出)。
• Surr. 0.3 m
Surr. 9 m
∼
-可以0.3 m為
增量進行距離設置。預設狀態為3 m。
• 該設置僅對以雙重單聲道編碼的杜比數位
或DTS音軌有效。有關聲道的資訊,請參
見碟片封套。
動態範圍控制
對杜比數位或DTS音軌指定動態範圍的調節幅
度:
-無動態範圍調節(當以較高音
LFE 衰減器設置
• DRC Off
量進行收聽時使用)
杜比數位和 DTS 音頻播放源包括了超低音音
調。請按需要設置LFE衰減器以防止超低音出
現聲音失真。
-中等設置
• DRC Mid
-動態範圍降低(較響的聲音
• DRC High
音量降低而較安靜的聲音音量增加)
-LFE聲道以無衰減狀態進行播
• LFE ATT 0
放
-LFE聲道以10dB進行衰減
• LFE ATT 10
-不播放LFE聲道
• LFE Off
該設置僅對杜比數位和某些DTS音軌有效。
對於其它播放源,您可以通過使用午夜模
式(請參見第34 頁“使用安靜和午夜聽
音模式”)創造類似的效果。
•
58
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
08
環繞聲設定
將遙控器切換至
收聽測試音。
,然後按
SUB
2
TEST TONE
設置聲道等級
您可以為各收聽模式設置與您的主要收聽位
置相關的聲道等級,其中包括所有的環繞聲以
及高級環繞聲模式。
測試音將按以下順序輸出(按當前收聽模式
從開啟的揚聲器中傳出):
• L -前置左揚聲器
如果您使用房間設定功能(第20 頁),則各
收聽模式的聲道等級將隨即被設置。但是,您
仍可以按需要對各等級進行微調。
• C -中置揚聲器
• R
-前置右揚聲器
-右環繞聲揚聲器
• RS
• LS
• SW
STANDBY/ON
-左環繞聲揚聲器
CD
FM/AM
TUNER
L1/L2
LINE
DVD
TV
-超低音揚聲器
DISPLAY
OPEN CLOSE
ꢃ
ꢋ
3
用 MASTER VOLUME+/- 按鈕將音量調節
至適當等級。
ꢅ
ꢄ
ꢀ
ꢈ
ꢌ
ꢌ
DVD MENU
RETURN
4
聲器等級。
ꢀ/ꢁ
(上/下光標)按鈕依次調節揚
用
ENTER
當您坐在主要收聽位置上時,您應該可以同樣
的音量聽到各揚聲器中傳出的測試音。聲道的
等級範圍為±10 dB。
MUTE
SOUND
MASTER
VOLUME
TV CONTROL
當您完成設置後,請按
5
設定。
退出測試音
ENTER
CH
INPUT
VOL
BASS MODE
AUTO
SURROUND ADVANCED
PROGRAM
AUDIO
REPEAT
RANDOM
ANGLE
SUBTITLE
HOME
MENU
ZOOM
1
TOP MENU
2
通過按
,然後用
CH LEVEL
(上/下
ꢀ/ꢁ
•
3
SYSTEM
TESTTONE
5
CH LEVEL
6
SETUP
光標)按鈕調節聲道等級,可在收聽任何
所需聲音播放源時對揚聲器音量進行調
節。當您完成了一個聲道的設置之後,請
4
QUIET/
TIMER/
DIMMER
7
MIDNIGHT
CLOCK
8
9
FOLDER–
0
FOLDER+
ENTER
CLR
ROOM SETUP
MAIN
SUB
用
ꢂ/ꢃ
置。
(左/右光標)按鈕移至下一設
反覆按
1
收聽模式。
或
選擇
ADVANCED
SURROUND
超低音揚聲器可產生超低頻率,因此其聲
音聽上去比實際的聲音要更為安靜。
•
59
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
09
視頻調節
選單
(Video Adjust)
第 9 章
(Video Adjust)
創建您自己的預設項
視頻調節
選單
視頻調節
預設狀態︰
(Video Adjust)
您最多創建二個您自己的預設項。
•
Standard
從視頻調節畫面您可以選擇標準視頻顯示或
者定義您自己的預設項。
選擇一個記憶預設項 (請參見上文)。
1
2
ꢁ
Detailed Settings
按
(下光標)選擇“
”
1
按 HOME MENU 從螢幕顯示選定“Video
ENTER
(詳細設置),再按
。
Adjust”(視頻調節)。
Video Adjust
Memory1
HOME MENU
DVD
Detailed Settings
Play Mode
Video Adjust
3
調節圖像質量設置值。
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
Memory1
Recall Settings
Contrast
Memory1
min
min
min
max
max
max
Brightness
用
2
設項。
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇一個預
ꢂ/ꢃ
Chroma Level
Video Adjust
Standard
用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇一個設置
ꢀ/ꢁ
•
•
項。
用
(左/右光標)按鈕調節當前設
ꢂ/ꢃ
標準-普通
•
置。
(記憶
)-用於保存您自
1-2
• Memory1-2
己的預設項(請參見下文)
• 按 DISPLAY 在全部顯示和單個顯示間切
換。
按
完成設置,退出
Video Adjust
3
ENTER
(視頻調節)畫面。
• 您可以通過 Recall Settings (調用設置)
選單項改變預設項號碼。
根據碟片和電視機/監視器的類型,您可
能無法看到明顯的效果。
•
60
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
09
視頻調節
選單
(Video Adjust)
您可以調節下列任一或全部圖像質量設置項:
(對比度) -在亮暗間調節對比
• Contrast
度。
• Brightness (亮度)-調節整體亮度。
• Chroma Level
的飽和程度。
(色度水平)-調節顏色
按
ENTER
保存預設項,退出視頻調節畫面。
4
61
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
第 10 章
(Initial Settings)
初始設置
選單
Digital Audio Mode Settings
(數位音頻模式設定)
如果您將外接的數位設備連接至光學數位輸
使用初始設置
選單
初始設置選單讓您能夠完全掌控DVD系統的設
(Initial Settings)
置,其中包括視頻輸出設置項,家長鎖定設置 出,則請進行這些設定。請注意,DVD唱碟和
項等。
SACD的音頻並非通過該光學插孔輸出。
如果某個選項呈灰色,表明此時該選項無法改
變。通常這是因為有碟片正在播放。請停止該
碟片的播放,然後改變設置。
Dolby Digital Out
(杜比數位輸出)
• 預設狀態︰Dolby Digital
1
按 HOME MENU,從螢幕顯示中選定
Initial Settings
“Initial Settings”(初始設置)。
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital > PCM
Linear PCM Out
HOME MENU
DVD
Display
Options
Play Mode
Video Adjust
Disc Navigator
Initial Settings
如果所連接的設備為杜比數位兼容,則將本設
定設為
為
(杜比數位),否則設
。如果您不確定該設
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital >PCM
備是否為杜比數位兼容,請查看隨該設備附帶
的手冊。
從左列選定設置類別,然後從右列中選定
2
項目。
進行您所要的設置。
3
(
DTS Out DTS
輸出)
DTS
預設狀態︰
•
Initial Settings
下文螢幕顯示圖例中顯示的語言選項可能
與用於貴國或貴地區的語言不同。
•
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
DTS
DTS > PCM
Linear PCM Out
Display
Options
62
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
如果所連接的設備具有內置式DTS解碼器,請
將本設定設為 ,否則設為 。如
Video Output settings (視頻
輸出設置)
DTS DTS>PCM
果您不確定該設備是否為DTS兼容,請查看隨
該設備附帶的手冊。
TV Screen TV
(
屏幕)
•
16:9 (Wide)
預設狀態︰
Initial Settings
如果對於非DTS兼容設備,您將本設定設為
了
•
•
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
4:3 (Letter Box)
4:3 (Pan&Scan)
16:9 (Wide)
TV Screen
,則當您播放DTS碟片時將輸出噪
DTS
Component Out
S-Video Out
音。
Display
Options
無論本設定為何,DTS-CD始終輸出DTS數位
音頻。
如果您的電視機是寬屏型,請選擇16:9 (Wide)
(寬屏)﹞
Linear PCM Out
PCM
輸出)
(線性
Down Sample Off
﹝
16:9
設定-寬屏 DVD 軟體將用全
•
預設狀態︰
屏進行顯示。在播放以傳統(4:3)格式錄製
的軟體時,您電視機上的設置將決定畫面以何
種方式呈現-關於哪些選項可用的詳細資訊,
請參見您電視機附帶的說明書。
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Dolby Digital Out
DTS Out
Down Sample On
Down Sample Off
Linear PCM Out
Display
如果您的電視機是傳統型,請選擇4:3 (Letter
Options
﹝
(信箱)﹞或
﹝
4:3 (Pan & Scan) 4:3
Box) 4:3
(全景掃描)﹞。在信箱模式下,寬屏軟體在
屏幕頂部和底部顯示有黑條。而全景掃描將削
去寬屏畫面的兩邊,以使其適於4:3屏幕(因
此盡管屏幕上的影像看上去大了,但實際上您
看到的圖像內容比原來少了)。同時請參見第
87頁“屏幕尺寸和碟片格式”。
如果所連接的設備與高取樣率(96 kHz)兼
容,請將本設定設為Down Sample Off,否
則設為Down Sample On (96 kHz 音頻轉
換為更為兼容的48 kHz)。如果您不確定該
設備是否為96 kHz兼容,請查看隨該設備附
帶的手冊。
即使本設定設為
,某些
Down Sample Off
•
碟片仍將通過數位輸出端輸出向下取樣的
音頻(您僅能通過模擬輸出端獲取全取樣
率的音頻)。
63
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
如果您連接的電視機不兼容逐行掃描信
號,卻將播放機切換為逐行模式,您將完
全看不到圖像。在這種情況下,請按
•
(分量輸出)
Component Out
僅本系統通過分量視頻輸出與電視機連接時,
ꢂ
才需要進行這項設置。
將系統切換至待機,然後
STANDBY/ON
預設狀態︰
•
Interlace
按住前面板上的 (停止)大約 8秒鐘直
ꢀ
至顯示幕上出現
。按住前面板
Mem.Clr.?
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
上的
或
按鈕,顯示幕上出現
VOL–
+
。按住前面板上的
TV Screen
Progressive
Interlace
Component Out
S-Video Out
按鈕設
Interlace?
ꢁ
Display
為逐行且重新打開本機。
Options
本系統對逐行掃描電視機的兼容性
本機與帶 Macro Vision系統拷貝保護技術的
逐行掃描視頻兼容。
如果您的電視機兼容逐行掃描,請設定為
Progressive
(逐行)以獲得無閃爍的視頻輸
出。如果您的電視機不兼容逐行掃描視頻信
Interlace
消費者請務必注意,並非所有的高清晰度電視機完全
兼容本產品,可能導致圖像中有異常信號顯示。如果
號,則請設定為
(隔行)。如果您
525
逐行掃描圖像出現問題,我們建議用戶將連接切
換到 “標準清晰度”(STANDARD DEFINITION)輸
出。如果有關於我公司電視機與本 播放機
無法確定您電視機的兼容性,請查看電視機附
帶的說明書。
525p DVD
兼容性的問題,請與我們的客戶服務中心聯繫。
本系統與下列先鋒顯示器和監視器兼容︰
PDP-503HDG,PDP-433HDG 逐行掃描兼容電視
機。
如果設定為
按一次
(逐行),您必須多
取消)。關於
RETURN
Progressive
(或按
ENTER
逐行掃描視頻的重要資訊請同時參見下文。
關於逐行掃描視頻
相較於隔行掃描視頻,逐行掃描視頻的圖像掃
描率提高了一倍,這樣生成的圖像極為穩定,
毫無閃爍。逐行掃描視頻僅通過分量視頻輸出
才能獲得。
• 當分量輸出(請參見上文)被設定為
Progressive (逐行)時,VIDEO 和 S-
插孔無視頻信號輸出。如果您想同
VIDEO
時在幾個監視器上顯示視頻信號,請確認
該項目被設定為Interlace (隔行)。
64
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
( 視頻輸出)
S
S-Video Out
僅當本系統用S視頻電纜與您的電視機連接
時,才需要進行這項設置。
您可以在播放過程中用
按鈕在DVD
AUDIO
•
影碟上所錄語言之間進行切換。(這不影
響本設置。)請參見第 48 頁“切換 DVD
影碟伴音語言”。
預設狀態︰
•
S2
Initial Settings
一些DVD影碟在裝入時會忽略
•
•
Audio
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
TV Screen
S1
S2
Component Out
S-Video Out
(伴音語言)設置,自動設定
Language
伴音語言。
Display
Options
帶有兩種以上伴音語言的碟片一般可從碟
片選單選擇伴音語言。要進入碟片選單,
請按DVD MENU 按鈕。
如果您發現在預設狀態
下圖像有拉伸
•
S2
或扭曲,請嘗試將設置改為 。
S1
(字幕語言)
Subtitle Language
預設狀態︰
•
English
(語言設
Language settings
置)
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
English
Audio Language (伴音語言)
French
Spanish
預設狀態︰
•
English
Display
Chinese
Options
Other Language
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
English
French
本設置項設定您首選的DVD影碟字幕語言。如
果碟片上錄製有您在此處指定的語言,本播放
機將自動以該語言字幕播放碟片。
Spanish
Display
Chinese
Options
Other Language
DVD影碟格式能夠識別136種不同的語言。如
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語言,請選
擇Other Language (其他語言)。請參見第
87頁“使用語言代碼列表選擇語言”。
本設置項設定您首選的DVD影碟伴音語言。如
果碟片上錄製有您在此處指定的語言,本系統
將自動以該語言播放碟片。
DVD影碟格式能夠識別136種不同的語言。如
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語言,請選
擇
(其他語言)。請同時參
Other Language
見第87頁“使用語言代碼列表選擇語言”。
65
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
(字幕顯示)
Subtitle Display
預設狀態︰
•
On
您可以在播放過程中用
按鈕改
SUBTITLE
•
•
•
Initial Settings
變或關閉 DVD 影碟上的字幕。(這不影響
本設置。)請參見第47頁“切換字幕”。
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
On
Off
一些DVD影碟在裝入時會忽略
Subtitle
Display
Options
(字幕語言)設置,自動設定
Language
字幕語言。
帶有兩種以上字幕語言的碟片一般可從碟
片選單選擇字幕語言。要進入碟片選單,
請按DVD MENU 按鈕。
當設為On時,播放機根據Subtitle Language
(字幕語言)設置顯示字幕。設定為Off 則關
閉全部字幕。
(
DVD Menu Language DVD
言)
選單語
Display settings
(顯示設置)
預設狀態︰
•
w/Subtitle Lang.
(
OSD Language OSD
語言)
Initial Settings
預設狀態︰
•
English
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Audio Language
Subtitle Language
DVD Menu Lang.
Subtitle Display
w/Subtitle Lang.
English
French
Initial Settings
Display
Spanish
Chinese
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
English
fran ais
Español
Options
Other Language
Display
Options
一些多語種碟片具有多種語言的碟片選單。本
設置項指定碟片選單的顯示語言。保留預設狀
本設置項設定播放機的螢幕顯示語言。
Subtitle Language
言)設置(請參見上文)相同的語言顯示。
態,選單將以與
(字幕語
(螢幕顯示)
On Screen Display
DVD影碟格式能夠識別136種不同的語言。如
果您想指定一種未在列表中列出的語言,請選
預設狀態︰
•
On
擇
(其他語言)。請參見第
Other Language
Initial Settings
87頁“使用語言代碼列表選擇語言”。
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
On
Off
Display
Options
66
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
本項目設定操作顯示是否在螢幕上出現
(播放), (恢復), (掃
﹝
Play
描)等﹞。
Resume Scan
並非所有您認為不適合於孩子觀看的碟片
都具有家長鎖定功能。這些碟片不需要輸
入密碼就能播放。
•
Angle Indicator
(角度指示器)
•
On
預設狀態︰
如果您忘記了密碼,則需要將播放機重置
為工廠設定(請參見第77頁“重置本系
統”),然後登錄一個新密碼。
•
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
OSD Language
On Screen Display
Angle Indicator
On
Off
登錄一個新密碼
在您改變家長鎖定級別或輸入國家代碼前,您
必須先登錄一個密碼。
Display
Options
1
選定 “Password”(密碼)。
如果您不想在播放DVD碟片的多視角畫面時在
屏幕上看見攝影機圖標,請將本設置改為Off。
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password
Bonus Group
Level Change
Country Code
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Options (選項)
Display
Options
Parental Lock
(家長鎖定)
• 默認級別︰Off
用數字按鈕輸入一個 位數密碼。
4
2
• 默認密碼︰無
Initial Settings
默認國家代碼︰
(
us 2119
)
•
一些DVD影碟有家長鎖定級別。如果您的播放
機設定的級別較碟片低,碟片將無法播放。這
樣,您就可以適當控制孩子在DVD系統中的觀
看內容。
Digital Audio Mode
Parental Lock: Register Code Number
Video Output
Language
*
*
*
*
Display
Options
一些碟片還支持國家代碼功能。根據您所設定
的國家代碼,播放機將不播放這些碟片上的某
些畫面。
您輸入的數字在螢幕上以星號(*)顯示。
在設定家長鎖定級別或國家代碼前,您必須先
登錄一個密碼。作為密碼擁有者,您可以隨時
改變家長鎖定級別或國家代碼。您也能改變密
碼。
67
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
按
3
面。
登錄該密碼並回到選項選單畫
按
4
面。
登錄新密碼並回到選項選單畫
ENTER
ENTER
如果您忘記了密碼,可以重置播放機,然後登
錄一個新密碼。關於如何重置播放機,請參見
第77頁“重置本系統”。
設置/改變家長鎖定級別
1
2
3
選定 “Level Change”(改變級別)。
改變您的密碼
要改變您的密碼,請先確認您當前的密碼,再
輸入一個新密碼。
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
Display
1
選定“Password Change”(改變密碼)。
Options
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
用數字按鈕輸入您的密碼,再按
。
ENTER
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
Display
Initial Settings
Options
Parental Lock : Level Change
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
用 數 字按 鈕 輸 入 您當 前 的 密 碼,再按
2
Options
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off
。
ENTER
當您輸入數字時,它們以星號顯示。
選擇一個新的級別。
Initial Settings
Parental Lock: Password Change
Digital Audio Mode
Initial Settings
Video Output
Password
*
*
*
*
Parental Lock : Level Change
Password
Language
Display
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
*
*
*
*
New Password
Options
Display
Options
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
off
輸入一個新的密碼。
3
反覆按ꢂ(左光標)鎖住更多級別(更多的
碟片需要密碼);按ꢃ(右光標)解鎖級別。
您無法鎖定級別1。
Initial Settings
Parental Lock: Password Change
Password
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
按
設定新的級別並回到選項選單畫
ENTER
Display
4
面。
New Password
Options
68
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
通過代碼數字進行選擇︰按
(右光
•
ꢃ
設置/改變國家代碼
您可能需要參見第88頁“國家(地區)代
碼列表”。
標),然後用數字按鈕輸入 4 位數的國家
代碼。(您可以參見第88 頁“國家(地區
) 代碼列表”。)
1
2
3
選定 “Country Code”(國家代碼)。
Initial Settings
Initial Settings
Parental Lock: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Password Change
Level Change
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Country Code
Country Code List
us
Code
Display
Options
2
1
1
9
Options
按
設定新的國家代碼並回到選項選
4 ENTER
單畫面。
用數字按鈕輸入您的密碼,再按
。
ENTER
Initial Settings
Parental Lock Change: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
•
對國家代碼設置的變更直到下一張碟片裝
入(或當前碟片重裝)後才生效。
Country Code List
us
Code
Options
2
1
1
9
Bonus Group (附送類)
選擇一個國家代碼。
有兩種方法可選擇國家代碼。
Initial Settings
通過代碼字母進行選擇︰用
(上/下
ꢀ/ꢁ
•
ꢄ
Off (us)
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
光標)改變國家代碼。
ꢄ
ꢄ
ꢄ
ꢄ
On
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Single
Display
DVD-Audio
2ch Area
Options
Initial Settings
Parental Lock: Country Code
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Display
Password
*
*
*
*
某些 DVD 唱碟具有額外的“附送”類,該類
需要4位數密碼。有關詳情和密碼請參見碟片
包裝。
Country Code List
us
Code
Options
2
1
1
9
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Bonus Group : Key Number Input
Video Output
Language
_
_
_
_
Display
Options
69
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
當您播放具有附送類的DVD唱碟時,密碼輸入
畫面將自動顯示。您也可以在此處進入該畫
面。
(分組播放)
Single
Group Playback
預設狀態︰
•
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
All
Single
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
如果您退出碟片、關閉電源或拔下播放機
的電源線,則需要重新輸入密碼。
•
Options
Auto Disc Menu
(自動碟片選單)
DVD唱碟可具有多達9個分組的曲目。當本設
定設為Single(單組),所選的分組播放,然
後碟片停止,或者返回到選單畫面。請使用搜
索功能(第 47 頁)選擇要播放的分組。(在
本模式中,您不能使用曲目跳躍 ꢌ /ꢍ 或
掃描按鈕ꢌ/ꢍ。)
• 預設狀態︰On
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
On
Off
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
如果您要連續播放碟片上的所有分組,請設為
All
(全部)。
該設定指定碟片裝入後選單(頂層選單)是
否自動顯示。如果您想要選單自動顯示,設為
,或者如果您不想要其顯示,設為
。
Off
On
• 即使本播放機被設為 All (全部)但若您
從碟片選單中選擇了一個分組以進行播
放,則僅該分組將播放。如果您停止播放,
則當您重新開始播放時,所有分組將再次
播放。
對於某些DVD碟片,無論該設定為何,都將
•
自動顯示選單。如果您在碟片裝入時按 ,
ꢄ
本設定將被忽略。
(
DVD Playback Mode DVD
式)
播放模
預設狀態︰DVD-Audio
•
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
DVD-Audio
DVD-Video
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
70
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
初始設置
選單
(Initial Settings)
某些DVD唱碟除DVD音頻外還包含DVD視頻內
容。將本設定設為DVD-Video(DVD視頻)可
以象DVD影碟那樣播放 DVD唱碟。請注意,此
時,僅碟片的DVD視頻部分進行播放。
(圖片瀏覽器)
On
PhotoViewer
預設狀態︰
•
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
On
Off
Bonus Group
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
Display
Options
當功能改變、碟片托盤被打開或者電源被
切換至待機模式時,本設定將轉換為DVD-
Audio(DVD音頻)。
•
如果您裝入的碟片同時包括 MP3 音頻文件和
JPEG圖片文件,則該項設置就十分重要。
SACD Playback SACD
(
播放)
On
文件。設定為
預設狀態
使您僅能觀看此類碟片上的JPEG
Off
• 預設狀態︰Multi-ch Area
將能夠播放MP3音頻文件。
Initial Settings
Digital Audio Mode
Video Output
Language
Parental Lock
Bonus Group
2ch Area
Multi-ch Area
CD Area
Auto Disc Menu
Group Playback
DVD Playback Mode
SACD Playback
Photo Viewer
• 對圖片瀏覽器設置的變更直到下一張碟片
裝入(或當前碟片重裝)後才生效。
Display
Options
SACD 碟片可以被分為多個不同的區域-立體
聲音頻( )、多聲道音頻(
2ch Area
)和用於雙層 SACD 的標準 CD 音頻
Multi-
ch Area
(
)。請選擇您要收聽的部分。
CD Area
如果裝入的碟片上沒有您選擇的區域,則
將播放其他區域。例如,如果您選擇標準
CD音頻,但所裝入的碟片不是雙層SACD,
則將播放立體聲SACD區域。
•
71
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
其它連接
第 11 章
其它連接
連接外接天線
連接輔助設備
該系統兼備立體聲模擬輸入與輸出端,亦具備
一個光學數位輸入端和一個光學數位輸出端。
請使用這些端子連接外接設備,例如您的VCR,
MD或者CD-R錄製機。
AM
請使用5-6米的乙烯絕緣電線並在室內或室外
外接
天線
進行安裝。保持AM環形天線的連接。
將
插孔連接至您電視機(或
)的音
VCR
•
頻輸出端。
TV
這使您能通過本系統來收聽電視機(或VCR)。
請使用RCA芯插頭的立體聲電纜進行連接。請
同樣參見第73頁“降低電視機和線路信號電
平”。
ENNA
5–6 m
BAL AM LOOP
ANTENNA
外接 FM 天線
Ω
請使用一根75 同軸電纜鉤住外接 FM天線。
AUDIO
OUTPUT
LINE1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
ATENNA
AUDIO
LINE1
OUT
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
FM UNBAL AM LOOP
75
ANTENNA
XV–DV900/XV–DV700
72
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
其它連接
將
(
)插孔連接至外部播放設備
將後面板上的
(
)插 孔
•
的模擬輸出端。
LINE1 IN
•
LINE1 OPTICAL IN
連接至外部播放設備的光學數位輸出端。
其中包括諸如VCR或錄音機之類的設備。請使
用RCA芯插頭的立體聲電纜進行連接。請同樣
參見下文“降低電視機和線路信號電平”。
OPT
ICAL
DIGIT
AL
IN
LINE
1
• 將 LINE 1(OUT)插孔連接至外部錄音設
備的模擬輸入端。
其中包括諸如錄音機、VCR、MD或具有模擬輸
入端的其它錄製機。請使用RCA芯插頭的立體
聲電纜進行連接。
其中包括諸如 MD播放機,數位衛星或遊戲系
統之類的數位設備。請使用光學數位電纜(未
隨機提供)進行連接。
降低電視機和線路信號電平
預設狀態:
•
ATT 6dB
AUDIO
INPUT
AUDIO
OUTPUT
某些播放源可能產生很高的信號等級,並可能
引起揚聲器發出難聽的聲音失真。在這種情況
下,您可能需要通過開啟衰減器來降低輔助播
放源(所連接的
或
或
模擬
LINE2
TV
LINE1
輸入)的信號等級。
將系統切換至待機狀態。
1
2
3
CAL
TAL
按 SYSTEM SETUP。
N
LINE1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
O
L
L
用
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “
TV
ꢂ/ꢃ
”或 “ ”或 “
LINE1 ATT? LINE2 ATT?
AUDIO
AUD
R
R
”,
LINE1
OUT
ATT?
然後按
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
。
ENTER
XV-DV900/XV-DV700
用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “
4
ꢀ/ꢁ
ATT
”,“
”或 “
”。
Off
ATT 6dB ATT 10dB
•
將後面板上的 OPTICAL DIGITAL OUT 插
孔連接至外部錄音設備的光學數位輸入端。
如果 ATT 6dB 設置仍然導致聲音失真,請嘗
試ATT 10dB 設置。
OPTICAL
5
按 ENTER 進行確認。
DIGIT
AL
OUT
73
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
其它連接
錄音模式
錄音模式讓您能夠通過
使用 S 視頻輸出端進行連接
如果您的電視機帶有S視頻輸入端,則您可以
使用該輸入端來代替標準視頻信號輸出端,以
獲得質量更好的圖像。
(
)插孔
LINE1 OUT
進行模擬錄音。
當開啟錄音模式後,大多數與聲音相關的功能
(包括 SURROUND,ADVANCED,AUTO,
SYSTEM SETUP)將處於未啟用狀態。如果您
•
S
S-VIDEO
使用 視頻電纜(未隨機提供)將
OUT
S
連接至您電視機上的 視頻輸入端。
試圖在錄音模式開啟時使用某一被禁功能,則
顯示幕將簡短閃爍RecMode On。
在插入電纜之前,請將插孔上方的小三角對準
插頭上的小三角。
當錄音模式關閉時,從模擬輸出端傳出的音頻
可能被中斷,這取決於操作本身。
1
2
SOUND
。
按
用
S-VIDEO
INPUT
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “
Rec
ꢂ/ꢃ
”。
Mode?
3
按 ENTER。
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇
用
4
“
ꢀ/ꢁ
”或 “
R.Mode On
”。
R.Mode Off
ANTENNA
•
On
時,多聲道DVD唱碟和
當錄音模式設為
E1
VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
SACD碟片的向下混合立體聲從揚聲器和模
擬音頻插口輸出. 請注意,對於某些DVD
VIDEO
AM
L
ANTE
L
AUDIO
PR
PB
Y
R
NE1
UT
Off
唱碟,僅前置左/右聲道輸出。當設為
TV
IN
LINE1
IN
LINE2
IN
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
時,多聲道DVD唱碟和SACD碟片通過所有
揚聲器播放,但前置左/右音頻從模擬音
頻插口輸出。
XV-DV900/XV-DV700
在播放SACD時若選擇
,本機將
R.Mode On
•
端開揚聲器SW輸出,低音將變得無法聽見。
S視頻輸出端可在S1和S2格式之間進行切
換以和所有電視機兼容。有關其詳細說明,
請參見第65頁“S-Video Out(S視頻輸
出)”。
•
74
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
其它連接
使用設備視頻輸出進行連接
如果您的電視機帶有設備視頻輸入端,則您可
以使用這些輸入端來代替標準視頻信號輸出
端,以將本系連接至您的電視機。在三種可選
的視頻輸出方式中,這會給您帶來最佳的圖像
質量。
•
使 用設 備 視 頻 電 纜 (未 隨 機提 供)將
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
上的一組份量輸入端。
連接至您電視機
COMPONENT
INPUT
ANTENNA
FBAL LOOP
TENNA
AUDIO
E1
LINE2
IN
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
N
XV-DV900/XV-DV700
份量視頻輸出端可在隔行掃描格式和逐行
格式之間進行切換。有關其詳細說明,請
參見第 64 頁“Component Out(分量輸
出)”。
•
75
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
第 12 章
附加資訊
按
進行確認。
ENTER
5
關閉演示
預設狀態:
•
Demo On
該系統具有自動演示功能,當系統第一次接通 改變時鐘格式
12-Hour
•
電源時,該功能開始運行。
預設狀態:
您可以選擇12或24 小時格式的時鐘顯示。
1
2
3
將系統切換至待機狀態。
將系統切換至待機狀態。
1
2
3
SYSTEM SETUP
按
用
。
按 SYSTEM SETUP。
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
ꢂ/ꢃ Demo
”,然後按
Mode?
。
ENTER
用
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “
12/
ꢂ/ꢃ
”,然後按
。
24 Hour?
ENTER
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “
12-
4
用 ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下光標)按鈕選擇“Demo
Off?”,然後按 ENTER 進行確認。
用
4
ꢀ/ꢁ
”或 “
Hour?
”。
24-Hour?
5
按 ENTER 進行確認。
在設置時鐘之後,演示模式自動關閉。但
是,如果您從電源插座上斷開系統電源,
演示模式將返回Demo On (且時鐘將被
•
改變頻率等級
• 預設狀態:FM 100 AM 10
復位)。
如果發現您無法成功地調諧電臺,則該頻率等
級可能不適合您所在的國家/地區。
童鎖
•
將系統切換至待機狀態。
1
2
3
預設狀態:
Lock Off
按
。
SYSTEM SETUP
該系統具有童鎖功能,可使前面板按鈕和控制
按鈕失去作用。
用 ꢂ/ꢃ (左/右光標)按鈕選擇 “FM
AM Step?”,然後按 ENTER。
1
2
將系統切換至待機狀態。
用
(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “
4
ꢀ/ꢁ
FM
”,然後按
按
用
。
SYSTEM SETUP
”或 “
50 AM 9?
FM100 AM 10?
進行確認。
(左/右光標)按鈕選擇“
Child
3
ꢂ/ꢃ
ENTER
”,然後按
。
ENTER
Lock?
4
用 ꢀ/ꢁ(上/下光標)按鈕選擇 “Lock
On?”或 “Lock Off?”。
76
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
設置電視制式
預設狀態:
在 PAL 制電視機 (MOD.PAL)
•
AUTO
上觀看 NTSC 節目
本系統的預設狀態為AUTO,除非您在播放某
多數採用新開發的分頻式PAL電視制式的電
視機能夠檢測50 Hz(PAL)/60 Hz(NTSC)
信號,並自動切換垂直幅度,從而生成垂直
方向無收縮的圖像。然而,在某些情況下,
圖像無色。
些碟片時發現圖像有失真,否則最好讓其保持
AUTO 預設狀態。如果對於某些碟片圖像出現
失真,請設置電視制式,以與您所在國家或地
區採用的制式相符。然而這樣做可能會限制某
些碟片的觀看。下表表明了各個設置(AUTO、
PAL 和NTSC)與哪些碟片兼容。
如果您的PAL電視機沒有V-Hold(垂直保持)
控制功能,則由於圖像滾動您可能無法觀看
NTSC碟片。如果電視機帶有V-Hold控制功能,
請對其進行調節直至圖像停止滾動。
1
2
3
將系統切換至待機狀態。
按
。
SYSTEM SETUP
在某些電視機上,圖像可能會垂直收縮,在屏
幕頂部和底部留下黑邊。這不是故障,而是由
NTSC到PAL的轉換造成的。
用
(左/右光標) 按鈕選擇 “
ꢂ/ꢃ
”,然後按
TV
。
ENTER
System?
用 ꢀ/ꢁ (上/下光標)按鈕選擇 Auto、
PAL 或 NTSC 然後按 ENTER 進行確認。
4
重置本系統
通過下述步驟,本系統的所有設置(電臺記憶
除外)將重置為工廠預設狀態。
碟片
播放機設置
1
2
將播放機切換到待機狀態。
按住前面板上的 (停止)按鈕大約
格式
NTSC
PAL
NTSC
NTSC
NTSC
NTSC
NTSC
PAL
AUTO
類型
DVD
MOD.PAL NTSC
秒
ꢀ
8
鐘直至顯示幕上出現 “
”。
Mem.Clr.?
PAL
PAL
Video CD NTSC
PAL
MOD.PAL NTSC
按前面板上的
按鈕。
3
ꢁ
現在播放機的所有設置值都已被重置,您將能
夠看到“Welcome to Pioneer DVD!(歡迎使
用先鋒DVD!)”畫面。
PAL
PAL
PAL
NTSC或
CD /無碟
—
NTSC
PAL
調節顯示幕亮度
預設狀態︰
•
3
本顯示幕具有三個亮度級別(1-3)。
按 DIMMER 改變顯示幕的亮度級別。
1
77
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
影碟區域
DVD
使用和保護碟片
所有DVD影碟都在其碟片盒的某處印有區域標
誌,這個標誌指明該碟片與世界上的哪些地區
兼容。您的DVD系統也有一個區域標誌,您可
以在後面板上找到它。來自非兼容區域的碟片
標題,章和曲目
DVD碟片一般被劃分為一個或多個標題。標題
可被進一步細分為章。
無法在本播放機上播放。標有
(所有區
ALL
域)的碟片可以在任意一臺播放機上播放。
下圖顯示全世界的各個DVD區域。
DVD唱碟一般被劃分為一個或多個組。每個組
可能包括許多曲目。
CD、SACD和VCD/超級VCD被劃分為曲目。
CD-ROM包括文件夾和文件。MP3文件被稱為曲
目。文件夾可能包括下一級文件夾。
78
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
拿取碟片 存儲碟片
拿取碟片時,注意不要在碟片表面留下指印, 雖然 CD和DVD碟片比乙烯唱碟更為耐用,您
灰塵或刮痕。手持碟片時持其邊緣或中心孔和
邊緣。
仍需注意進行正確拿放和保存。碟片不用時,
應放回碟片盒中豎立放置。請避免將碟片置於
過冷,過濕或過熱的環境中(包括陽光直射
的環境)。
受損或弄髒的碟片會影響播放性能。同樣應注
意不要刮傷碟片的標籤面,雖然此面不如錄製
面易受損,但是刮痕仍可能導致碟片無法使
用。
請勿在碟片上粘貼紙張或粘貼紙,或對其使用
鉛筆,圓珠筆或其他帶有尖端的書寫工具。否
則會損壞碟片。
如果碟片沾上指印,灰塵等,使用柔軟的乾布
清潔,如下圖所示由中心向外緣輕輕擦拭碟
片。
有關碟片保養的更多信息,請參見碟片說明。
請勿在播放機中同時裝入多張碟片。
不可使用的碟片
碟片在播放機內將進行高速旋轉。如果您發現
按直線軌跡從碟片中心開始輕輕地擦拭。
勿沿圓周軌跡旋轉擦拭碟片表面。
碟片破裂,破損,曲翹或受到其他損壞,請勿
冒險在本機內使用,否則會損壞本機。
如有必要,用蘸取酒精的布或市售的 CD/DVD
清潔工具徹底清潔碟片。切勿使用苯,稀釋劑
或其他清潔劑,包括設計用於清潔乙烯唱碟的
產品。
本機僅適合使用常規的圓形碟片。切勿在本機
中使用異形碟片。對於因使用異形碟片而導致
的任何後果,先鋒公司不承擔任何責任。
79
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
清潔拾取頭
本系統正確安裝和維護
DVD播放機的拾取頭在正常使用情況下應不會
變髒,但是如果出於某些原因因灰塵或髒污而
出現故障,應咨詢鄰近的先鋒授權服務中心。
雖然市面上售有拾取頭清潔劑,但是我們建議
不要使用這類產品,因為有些清潔劑可能會損
壞拾取頭。
安裝提示
我們衷心希望本機能長久地為您服務,所以當
您選擇合適的安裝位置時請務必遵循以下幾
點:
請務必⋯
在通風良好的房間內使用。
ꢄ
關於結露問題
如果將播放機從室外搬入溫暖的房間,或者房
ꢄ放置在堅固,平整的水平表面上,如桌子,
擱架或立體聲機架上。
間溫度升高太快,播放機內部可能會有結露。
雖然結露不會損壞播放機,但會暫時影響播放
機的性能。鑒於這一原因,應將播放機在溫暖
溫度下放置一小時左右,然後再開機使用。
請勿⋯
ꢅ
ꢅ
放置在高溫或高濕場所,包括散熱器或其
他發熱器具附近。
放置在窗臺或其他使播放機受到陽光直射
的地方。
搬移本機
如果您需要搬移本機,請先按前面板上的
ꢂ
在多塵或潮濕環境中使用。
ꢅ
ꢅ
,將播放機關閉。請等至
STANDBY/ON
Good
從顯示幕上消失後再拔下電源線。切勿在
直接放置在放大器或立體聲系統中的其他
在使用時會發熱的設備的頂部。
Bye
播放時提起或搬移本機。因為此時,碟片將以
高速旋轉,可能會受到損壞。
ꢅ 放置在電視機或顯視器(尤其是使用室內
天線的電視機)附近,否則可能會產生干
擾。
ꢅ 放置在廚房或其他會使播放機置身於煙霧
或蒸汽的場所。
•
Good Bye
在
消失之前請勿關閉本機,否
則本系統會返回至出廠設置。
放置在厚重的地毯或墊子上,或者用布匹
ꢅ
將本機覆蓋住。因為這樣,會妨礙本機散
熱。
放置在不平穩的表面或者面積不足以支撐
ꢅ
四個機腳的表面上。
80
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
電源線注意事項
請手持插頭部分插拔電源線。拔插頭時請勿拉
扯電線。當您雙手潮濕時切勿觸碰電源線,否
則可能會引起短路或電擊。請勿將本機,家具
或其他物體放置在電源線上,或者緊壓電源
線。切勿使電源線打結,或者與其他電線扎在
一起。電源線的布線應使其無法被踩到。損壞
的電源線會引起火災或電擊事故。
請定期檢查電源線。如果您發現電源線受損,
請就近聯繫先鋒授權服務中心或經銷商予以
更換。
81
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
故障排除
不正確的操作通常會引起故障和失靈。如果您認為該設備出了問題,請檢查以下內容。有時候
故障可能位於另一設備中。請檢查其它所使用的設備和電器。即使執行了如下所列的檢查,仍
不能解決故障,請聯繫附近的先鋒授權服務中心或者您的經銷商以進行修理工作。
如果由於靜電等外部影響而使系統無法正常工作,請將電源插頭從插座處斷開,並再次插
入返回正常工作狀態。
•
一般
問題
措施
•
•
電源無法開啟。
將電源插頭連接至電源插座。
將電源插頭從插座上斷開,並再次插入。
•請確保揚聲器電線中沒有鬆動的線頭與後面板接觸。否則可能導致系統自
動關閉。
當選擇了某一功能時,•如果您使用了線路輸入,請確保設備的正確連接(請參見第72頁“連接
沒有聲音輸出。
輔助設備”)。
•請按遙控器上的 MUTE 以關閉靜音。
•調節 VOLUME (音量)。
播放碟片時沒有圖像輸 •請確保電視機的正確連接 (請參見安裝指南)。
出。
請將視頻輸出復位至隔行掃描 〔請參見第64頁“Component Out(分量
•
輸出)”〕
沒有聲音從環繞聲揚聲 請參見第59頁“設置聲道等級”以檢查揚聲器等級。
•
器或中置揚聲器中傳
出。
請檢查您是否選擇了
•
收聽”)。
聲音模式(請參見第30頁“用環繞聲進行
STEREO
請檢查是否開啟了虛擬模式(請參見第32頁“使用高級環繞聲效果”)。
請正確連接各揚聲器 (請參見安裝指南)。
•
•
•
•
無法操作遙控器。
請更換電池 (請參見安裝指南)。
在 7米,30°的範圍內對前面板上的遙控器感應窗進行操作(請參見安裝
指南)。
•
•
請移去所有障礙物或換個位置進行操作。
請避免將前面板上的遙控器感應窗暴露在直射光下。
•
沒有顯示
請確保所有設備均連接正確。
82
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
問題
措施
•
定時器指示器閃爍,且 請斷開本機電源,然後再接通。等待一分鐘後開啟。
系統無法開啟。
•請確保本機 AMP部分的風扇沒有被堵住。
•請檢查揚聲器已正確連接。
•如果問題仍然存在,請把它帶至附近的先鋒授權服務中心或者您的經銷商
處進行修理。
DVD/CD/VCD
播放機
問題
措施
碟片在裝入後自動彈 •請清潔碟片。
出。
•請將碟片正確對準碟片導軌。
•如果DVD 影碟的區域編號和播放機不匹配,碟片將無法使用 (請參見第
78頁“DVD影碟區域”)。
•請等待一段時間使播放機內部的結露蒸發。請避免在空調附近使用播放
機。
無法進行播放。
•如果碟片裝反,請將標籤面朝上重新裝入碟片。
圖像播放停止,且無法 請按 (停止),然後按 (播放)開始重新播放。
• ꢀ
ꢄ
使用操作按鈕。
請關閉電源一次,然後再次使用前面板上的
•
啟。
按鈕進行開
ꢂ STANDBY/ON
設置被取消。
因停電或電源線被拔出而使電源被切斷,設置將被取消。
•
•
沒有圖像/沒有顏色。 請檢查各項連接是否正確,插頭是否完全插入。
•
設置。
請檢查電視機/監視器的指導手冊以確保電視機/監視器進行了正確的
•
如果您的電視機/監視器使用S視頻電纜進行連接,則請嘗試改變S視頻輸
出設定〔請參見第65頁“S-Video Out(S視頻輸出)”〕。
•TV Screen
)設置不正確。請設置電視機屏幕選項以匹配您所使用
畫面被拉長或縱橫比未
改變。
(TV屏幕
的電視機/監視器〔請參見第63頁“TV Screen(TV屏幕)”〕。
•
當在VCR上錄音或經過 本系統採用防拷貝技術,可在連接有VCR或AV選擇器時防止錄音或者引起
AV選擇器時,在圖像播
放中存在干擾。
圖像問題。這並非故障。
83
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
問題
措施
•
在播放期間圖像受到干 播放機與 Macro-Vision系統的防拷貝兼容。某些碟片含有防拷貝信號,當
擾或者變暗。
播放這類碟片時,可能會看到圖像的一些部分上出現條紋等情況,這取決
於電視機的情況。而並非故障。
•碟片對特殊播放機功能有不同的反應。當執行該功能時,可能導致畫面短
時間變黑或輕微抖動。這些問題主要歸因於碟片之間以及碟片內容之間的
差異,並非播放機的故障。
DVD和CD音量出現顯著 •DVD 和CD使用不同的錄製方法。這並非故障。
差異。
收聽DVD唱碟時,耳機 •某些多聲道 DVD唱碟通過耳機僅輸出前置/右置聲道。
輸出的聲音不完整。
MP3/JPEG
碟片
問題
措施
•
本系統無法識CD-ROM碟 確保使用以 ISO 9660碟片格式錄製的CD-ROM。有關其它碟片兼容性的資
片。
訊,請參見第9頁“一般碟片兼容性”。
•
文件在碟片導向/圖片 碟片上的文件必須以正確的文件擴展名命名︰ MP3文件為.mp3;JPEG文件
瀏覽器中不顯示。
為.jpg(大小寫均可)。有關其他碟片兼容性的資訊,請參見第9頁“一
般碟片兼容性”。
•
Off
以能訪問MP3文件。
JPEG文件顯示,但 MP3 將初始設定選單中的圖片瀏覽器選單選項設置為
文件不顯示。
請參見第71頁“PhotoViewer (圖片瀏覽器)”。
84
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
調諧器
問題
措施
無線電廣播有大量噪 請正確連接天線 (請參見安裝指南)。
•
音。
•
•
•
•
請完全伸展 FM有線天線,置於最佳接收位置並固定在牆上。
請連接一根外接 FM天線(請參見第72頁“連接外接天線”)。
請調節方向與位置以獲得最佳接收。
請連接一根附加的室內或外接 AM天線(請參見安裝指南和第72頁“連接
外接天線”)。
•
•
請關閉任何其它可能導致噪音的設備或者將它遠離主機放置。
調諧間隔不符合您所在國家或地區。請試著切換調諧間隔 (請參見第76
頁“改變頻率等級”)。
自動調諧無法搜索到某 •無線電信號較弱。自動調諧將僅偵測到信號良好的廣播電臺。如果要獲得
些電臺。
靈敏度高的調諧效果,請連接一根室外天線。
聲音只有單聲道效果。 •請檢查調諧器是否設置為 FM單聲道(請參見第 28頁“改善不良的FM接
收”)。
錯誤訊息
訊息
說明
Child Lock
•
當童鎖功能開啟時,如果按下了前面板的按鈕,則出現該訊息。有關開啟/
關閉兒童鎖定的詳細說明,請參見第76頁“童鎖”
。
Rec Mode On
•由於錄音模式的開啟而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍 2秒(請參見第
74頁“錄音模式”)。
Phones In
•由於連接有耳機而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍 2秒。
96K Stereo
•由於播放源為數位88.2或96kHz PCM而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍
2秒。
No Surr. SP
Muting
•由於沒有環繞聲揚聲器輸出而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍 2秒。
由於聲音被靜音而禁止某一操作時,該訊息快速閃爍2秒(請參見第36頁
•
“靜音”)。
Exit
在短暫間歇之後某一選單自動退出時,簡短出現該訊息。
•
85
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
訊息
說明
DVD-AUDIO
•
裝入 DVD唱碟後,當以下某個按鈕按下時該訊息快速閃爍。
‧AUTO ‧SURROUND ‧ADVANCED ‧DIALOGUE ‧VIRTUAL SB
‧BASS MODE
SACD
•裝入 SACD唱碟後,當以下某個按鈕按下時該訊息快速閃爍。
‧AUTO ‧SURROUND ‧ADVANCED ‧DIALOGUE ‧VIRTUAL SB
‧BASS MODE
86
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
設為
4:3
請注意,某些電影縱橫
屏幕尺寸和碟
片格式
使用語言代碼
比大於 16:9,所以即 (
)時,寬
Pan&Scan
列表選擇語言
某些語言選項〔請參
見第65頁“Language
settings(語 言 設
置)”〕可讓您能夠從
第88 頁“語言代碼列
表”中任選136種語言
之一作為您首選的語
言。
使您的電視機是寬屏 屏碟片會削去畫面的
的,碟片仍以信箱格式 兩邊。雖然圖像看起來
播放,在屏幕的頂部和 大了,但您所看到的並
DVD影碟可適用於幾種
不同的屏幕縱橫比,從
電視節目(一般為4:3
格式)至CinemaScope
系統的寬屏電影(縱
橫比最高達7:3)。
底部顯示有黑條。
不是整個畫面。
標準電視機用戶
如果您的電視機是標
準型,本播放機的
電視機也可使用不同
的縱橫比,標準4:3和
寬屏16:9。
TV
(第63頁)設
Screen
置可按照您的喜好設
1
選定 “Other
請注意,許多寬屏碟片
會忽略播放機的設定,
以至無論設定為何,均
以信箱格式顯示。
Language”(其他語
言)。
定為
(
4:3 Letter
寬屏電視機用戶
如果您的電視機是寬
屏型,本播放機的
)或
Box
(
4:3
)。
Pan&Scan
用
(左/右
ꢂ/ꢃ
光 標)選擇是使 用代
2
TV
(第63頁)設
設為
(
4:3 Letter
)時,寬屏碟片會
Screen
置應設定為
碼字母還是代碼數字。
Box
16:9
在屏幕的頂部和底部
顯示黑條。
(
)。
用
(上/下
ꢀ/ꢁ
光 標)選擇代碼 字母
Wide
3
將標準4:3電視機
設為
•
當您觀看以4:3格式錄
製的碟片時,您可以使
用電視機控制按鈕來
選定畫面的顯示方式。
您的電視機可以提供
不同的縮放和拉伸選
項;詳情請參見電視機
附帶的說明書。
16:9
),或將寬
或代碼數字。
(
Wide
屏電視機設為任
何一種 格式,
關於語言和代碼的完
整列表,請參見第 88
頁“語言代碼列表”。
4:3
都會導致畫面失
真。
87
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
語言代碼列表
語言(語言代碼字母),語言代碼
Japanese (ja), 1001
English (en), 0514
French (fr), 0618
German (de), 0405
Italian (it), 0920
Spanish (es), 0519
Dutch (nl), 1412
Russian (ru), 1821
Chinese (zh), 2608
Korean (ko), 1115
Greek (el), 0512
Basque (eu), 0521
Persian (fa), 0601
Finnish (fi), 0609
Fiji (fj), 0610
Faroese (fo), 0615
Frisian (fy), 0625
Lithuanian (lt), 1220
Latvian (lv), 1222
Malagasy (mg), 1307
Maori (mi), 1309
Macedonian (mk), 1311
Malayalam (ml), 1312
Mongolian (mn), 1314
Moldavian (mo), 1315
Marathi (mr), 1318
Malay (ms), 1319
Maltese (mt), 1320
Burmese (my), 1325
Nauru (na), 1401
Samoan (sm), 1913
Shona (sn), 1914
Somali (so), 1915
Albanian (sq), 1917
Serbian (sr), 1918
Siswati (ss), 1919
Sesotho (st), 1920
Sundanese (su), 1921
Swedish (sv), 1922
Swahili (sw), 1923
Tamil (ta), 2001
Telugu (te), 2005
Tajik (tg), 2007
Thai (th), 2008
Tigrinya (ti), 2009
Turkmen (tk), 2011
Tagalog (tl), 2012
Setswana (tn), 2014
Tonga (to), 2015
Turkish (tr), 2018
Irish (ga), 0701
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704
Galician (gl), 0712
Guarani (gn), 0714
Gujarati (gu), 0721
Hausa (ha), 0801
Hindi (hi), 0809
Croatian (hr), 0818
Hungarian (hu), 0821
Armenian (hy), 0825
Interlingua (ia), 0901
Interlingue (ie), 0905
Inupiak (ik), 0911
Indonesian (in), 0914
Icelandic (is), 0919
Hebrew (iw), 0923
Yiddish (ji), 1009
Javanese (jw), 1023
Georgian (ka), 1101
Kazakh (kk), 1111
Greenlandic (kl), 1112
Cambodian (km), 1113
Kannada (kn), 1114
Kashmiri (ks), 1119
Kurdish (ku), 1121
Kirghiz (ky), 1125
Latin (la), 1201
Afar (aa), 0101
Abkhazian (ab), 0102
Afrikaans (af), 0106
Amharic (am), 0113
Arabic (ar), 0118
Assamese (as), 0119
Aymara (ay), 0125
Azerbaijani (az), 0126
Bashkir (ba), 0201
Byelorussian (be), 0205
Bulgarian (bg), 0207
Bihari (bh), 0208
Bislama (bi), 0209
Bengali (bn), 0214
Tibetan (bo), 0215
Breton (br), 0218
Catalan (ca), 0301
Corsican (co), 0315
Czech (cs), 0319
Nepali (ne), 1405
Norwegian (no), 1415
Occitan (oc), 1503
Oromo (om), 1513
Oriya (or), 1518
Panjabi (pa), 1601
Polish (pl), 1612
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Tsonga (ts), 2019
Portuguese (pt), 1620
Quechua (qu), 1721
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),
1813
Kirundi (rn), 1814
Romanian (ro), 1815
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823
Sanskrit (sa), 1901
Sindhi (sd), 1904
Sangho (sg), 1907
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908
Sinhalese (si), 1909
Slovak (sk), 1911
Tatar (tt), 2020
Twi (tw), 2023
Ukrainian (uk), 2111
Urdu (ur), 2118
Uzbek (uz), 2126
Vietnamese (vi), 2209
Volap?k (vo), 2215
Wolof (wo), 2315
Xhosa (xh), 2408
Yoruba (yo), 2515
Zulu (zu), 2621
Welsh (cy), 0325
Danish (da), 0401
Bhutani (dz), 0426
Esperanto (eo), 0515
Estonian (et), 0520
Lingala (ln), 1214
Laothian (lo), 1215
Slovenian (sl), 1912
國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼列表
國家(地區)、國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼、國家 ( 地區 ) 代碼字母
0118 ar
0609 fi
1325 my
1907 sg
阿根廷,
澳洲,
奧地利,
,
芬蘭,
法國,
德國,
香港,
,
馬來西亞,
墨西哥,
荷蘭,
,
新加坡,
西班牙,
0519 es
瑞士,
,
,
,
,
,
0121 au
0618 fr
1324 mx
,
,
,
,
0120 at
0205 be
0405 de
0811 hk
1412 nl
1905 se
0308 ch
1426 nz
比利時,
,
,
紐西蘭,
,
瑞典,
,
巴西, 0218, br
印度, 0914, in
挪威, 1415, no
巴基斯坦,
臺灣, 2023, tw
加拿大,
,
印度尼西亞,
,
,
泰國,
,
0301 ca
0904 id
1611 pk
2008 th
0312 cl
0920 it
1608 ph
0702 gb
美國, 2119, us
智利,
,
義大利,
,
菲律賓,
葡萄牙, 1620, pt
俄羅斯聯邦, ,
,
英國,
,
中國, 0314, cn
丹麥,
日本, 1016, jp
韓國,
,
,
0411 dk
1118 kr
1821 ru
88
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
預設代碼列表
請注意,可能在分配了正確的預設代碼後只能控制部分功能,也有可能列表中的製造商代碼對
您使用的機型無效。
製造商 代碼
ACURA 644
ADMIRAL 631
AIWA 660
AKAI 632, 635, 642
AKURA 641
ALBA 607, 639, 641, 644
AMSTRAD 642, 644, 647
ANITECH 644
ASA 645
FERGUSON 607, 636, 651
FINLANDIA 635, 643, 655
FINLUX 632, 607, 645, 648, KAISUI 618, 641, 644
653, 654, 655
JEC 605
JVC 613, 623
PALLADIUM 638
PANAMA 646
PANASONIC 631, 607,
608,642, 622
PATHO CINEMA 642
PAUSA 644
PHILCO 632, 642
PHILIPS 631, 607, 634, 656
PHOENIX 632
KAPSCH 631
KENDO 642
KENNEDY 632, 642
KORPEL 607
FIRSTLINE 640, 644
FISHER 632, 635, 638, 645
FORMENTI 632, 607, 642
FRONTECH 631, 642, 646
KOYODA 644
FRONTECH/PROTECH 632 LEYCO 607, 640, 646, 648
ASUKA 641
FUJITSU 648, 629
FUNAI 640, 646, 658
GBC 632, 642
GE 601, 608, 607, 610, 617, M-ELECTRONIC 631, 644,
602, 628, 618
GEC 607, 634, 648
GELOSO 632, 644
GENEXXA 631, 641
GOLDSTAR 610, 623, 621, MAGNAVOX 607, 610,
602, 607, 650
LIESENK&TTER 607
LOEWE 607
LUXOR 632, 642, 643
PHONOLA 607
AUDIOGONIC 607, 636
BASIC LINE 641, 644
BAUR 631, 607, 642
BEKO 638
PROFEX 642, 644
PROTECH 607, 642, 644,
646, 649
QUELLE631, 632, 607, 642,
645, 653
R-LINE 607
RADIOLA 607
645, 654, 655, 656, 607,
636, 651
MAGNADYNE 632, 649
MAGNAFON 649
BEON 607
BLAUPUNKT 631
BLUE SKY 641
BLUE STAR 618
BPL 618
RADIOSHACK 610, 623,
621, 602
603, 612, 629
BRANDT 636
BTC 641
BUSH 607, 641, 642, 644,
647, 656
CASCADE 644
CATHAY 607
CENTURION 607
CGB 642
GOODMANS 607, 639,
647, 648, 656
GORENJE 638
MANESTH 639, 646
MARANTZ 607
MARK 607
MATSUI 607, 639, 640,
642, 644, 647, 648
MCMICHAEL 634
MEDIATOR 607
MEMOREX 644
METZ 631
MINERVA 631, 653
MITSUBISHI 609, 610, 602, SAMSUNG 607, 638, 644,
621, 631
MULTITECH 644, 649
NEC 659
RBM 653
RCA 601, 610, 615, 616,
617, 618, 661, 662, 609
REDIFFUSION 632, 642
REX 631, 646
ROADSTAR 641, 644, 646
SABA 631, 636, 642, 651
SAISHO 639, 644, 646
SALORA 631, 632, 642, 643
SAMBERS 649
GPM 641
GRAETZ 631, 642
GRANADA 607, 635, 642,
643, 648
GRADIENTE 630, 657
GRANDIN 618
GRUNDIG 631, 653
HANSEATIC 607, 642
HCM 618, 644
HINARI 607, 641, 644
HISAWA 618
HITACHI 631, 633, 634,
636, 642, 643, 654, 606,
610, 624, 625, 618
HUANYU 656
HYPSON 607, 618, 646
ICE 646, 647
IMPERIAL 638, 642
INDIANA 607
INGELEN 631
CIMLINE 644
CLARIVOX 607
CLATRONIC 638
CONDOR 638
CONTEC 644
CROSLEY 632
CROWN 638, 644
CRYSTAL 642
CYBERTRON 641
DAEWOO 607, 644, 656
DAINICHI 641
DANSAI 607
DAYTON 644
DECCA 607, 648
DIXI 607, 644
DUMONT 653
ELIN 607
646
SANYO 635, 645, 648, 621,
614
SBR 607, 634
NECKERMANN 631, 607
NEI 607, 642
NIKKAI 605, 607, 641, 646, SCHNEIDER 607, 641, 647
SCHAUB LORENZ 642
648
SEG 642, 646
NOBLIKO 649
SEI 632, 640, 649
SELECO 631, 642
SHARP 602, 619, 627
SIAREM 632, 649
SIEMENS 631
SINUDYNE 632, 639, 640,
649
NOKIA 632, 642, 652
NORDMENDE 632, 636,
651, 652
OCEANIC 631, 632, 642
INTERFUNK 631, 632, 607, ORION 632, 607, 639, 640
642
INTERVISION 646, 649
ISUKAI 641
ITC 642
OSAKI 641, 646, 648
OSO 641
OSUME 648
OTTO VERSAND 631, 632, SONOKO 607, 644
607, 642 SONOLOR 631, 635
ELITE 641
ELTA 644
EMERSON 642
ERRES 607
SKANTIC 643
SOLAVOX 631
ITT 631, 632, 642
89
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
SONTEC 607
SONY 604
SOUNDWAVE 607
STANDARD 641, 644
STERN 631
SUSUMU 641
SYSLINE 607
TANDY 631, 641, 648
TASHIKO 634
TATUNG 607, 648
TEC 642
TELEAVIA 636
TELEFUNKEN 636, 637, 652
TELETECH 644
TENSAI 640, 641
THOMSON 636, 651, 652, 663
THORN 631, 607, 642, 645, 648
TOMASHI 618
TOSHIBA 605, 602, 626, 621, 653
TOWADA 642
ULTRAVOX 632, 642, 649
UNIVERSUM 631, 607, 638, 642, 645, 646, 654, 655
VESTEL 607
VICTOR 613
VOXSON 631
WALTHAM 643
WATSON 607
WATT RADIO 632, 642, 649
WHITE
WESTINGHOUSE 607
YOKO 607, 642, 646
ZENITH 603, 620
PIONEER 600, 631, 632, 607, 636, 642, 651
90
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
杜比數位
術語
1
模擬音頻
直接表現聲音的電信號。請與可以為電信號但
對聲音間接表現的數位音頻相比較。可參見
“數位音頻”。
採用最多為5.1聲道的音頻,這種高質量的環
繞聲系統被應用於世界上許多高級電影院中。
螢幕顯示可表明哪一個聲道正在使用中,例如
顯示 3/2.1時,3 為兩個前聲道和中央聲道;
2為環繞聲聲道,1是LFE聲道。
縱橫比
電視屏幕寬度相對高度的比。傳統電視縱橫比
為4:3(換言之,屏幕接近於正方形);寬屏
電視機為16:9(屏幕的寬幾乎是高的兩倍)。
杜比專業邏輯/專業邏輯
II
DVD
附送類 (僅用於
唱碟)
某些 DVD 唱碟具有“附送”類,該類需要密
碼才能獲取。請參見第 69 頁“Bonus Group
(附送類)”。
矩陣解碼系統可自2個聲道播放源中提取4.1
(杜比專業邏輯)或者 5.1(杜比專業邏輯
II)聲道環繞聲。
DVD
可瀏覽圖片 (僅用於
唱碟)
DTS
某些DVD唱碟具有該功能,使用戶在播放音頻
時可瀏覽錄製在碟片上的靜像。請參見“圖
片放映”。
R
DTS代表Digital Theater System(數位影院
系統)。DTS 是一種不同於杜比數位的環繞聲
系統,它已經成為電影中較普及的環繞聲格
式。
數位音頻
通過數字對聲音間接表現。錄製過程中,聲音
通過模數轉換器以離散的間隔進行測定(CD
音頻為每秒 44,100 次),生成數字流。播放
時,數模轉換器再根據這些數字生成模擬信
號。可參見“取樣頻率”和“模擬音頻”。
動態範圍
音頻信號中最響聲音和最輕聲音之間的差值
(沒有失真或沒有在噪聲中損失)。杜比數位
和DTS聲道都有很寬的動態範圍,能夠產生影
院級的動態效果。
91
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
EXIF
MPEG
視頻
(可交換圖像文件)
這是由Fuji Photo Film開發的一種用於數位
相機的文件格式。許多廠商生產的數位相機都
使用這種壓縮的文件格式,它帶有日期,時間
和縮略圖資訊以及圖片數據。
用於VCD和DVD碟片的一種視頻格式。VCD採
用較早的 MPEG-1標準,而DVD採用更新,質
量更好的MPEG-2標準。
PBC
(播放控制)(僅用於
VCD/
VCD
超級 )
通過錄製在碟片上的螢幕顯示選單瀏覽 VCD/
超級VCD的一種系統。尤其適用於不是一次從
頭看到尾的碟片,例如卡拉OK碟片。
文件擴展名
加在文件末尾的標籤,表示文件的類型。例
如,“.mp3”表示MP3文件。
ISO 9660
格式
CD-ROM碟片容量和文件結構的國際標準。
PCM
(脈碼調制)
CD 和 DAT 上最常見的數位音頻編碼系統。質
量絕佳,但是與杜比數位和 MPEG 音頻等格式
相比,需要大量的數據。可參見“數位音頻 ”。
JPEG
靜像(如照片和插圖)的文件格式。JPEG 文
件以“.jpg”或“.JPG”擴展名識別。絕大
部分的數位相機都採用這種格式。
DVD
區域 (僅用於
影碟)
將碟片和播放機與世界上的特定區域聯繫在
一起。本機僅播放具有兼容區域代碼的碟片。
您可以在後面板上看到本機的區域代碼。有的
碟片與不止一個的區域兼容(或與所有區域
兼容)。
MP3
MP3(MPEG1 音頻層 3)是一種壓縮的音頻文
件格式。文件以 “.mp3”或“.MP3”擴展名
識別。
S1 S
視頻輸出
該S視頻信號格式在視頻信號中包含縱橫比資
MLP
這是一種無損的壓縮格式,可使DVD唱碟中保
PCM
DVD
(僅用於 唱碟)
/壓縮
訊(4:3或16:9)。
存的PCM音頻比其他方式所保存的多。
S2 S
視頻輸出
S2是S 視頻的增強版,它除了縱橫比資訊外,
還包含letterbox/pan & scan資訊。與 S2 S
視頻兼容的寬屏電視機可根據信號自動切換
至合適的模式。
MPEG
音頻
用於VCD和一些DVD碟片的一種音頻格式。本
機可以將MPEG 音頻轉換成PCM格式,以更好
地與數位錄製設備和AV放大器兼容。可參見
“PCM(脈碼調制)”。
92
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
取樣頻率
轉換成數位音頻數據時聲音的測量頻率。頻率
越高,音質越好,但是將生成更多的數位資
訊。標準 CD 音頻的取樣頻率為 44.1kHz,即
指每秒取樣(測量)44,100次。可參見“數
位音頻”。
DVD VCD/
圖片放映 (
VCD
)
、
超級
某些DVD 碟片和VCD/ 超級 VCD具有該功能,
可使錄製在碟片上的靜像在播放音頻時自動
循環播放。請參見“可瀏覽圖片”。
SACD
超級音頻 (
)
超級音頻 CD 是一種高質量的音頻碟片格式,
可在同一張碟片上容納高取樣頻率立體聲和
多聲道音頻,以及常規CD音頻。
93
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
重量︰
DVD/CD調諧器 ......................3.2 kg
顯示幕.............................0.2 kg
規格
放大器部分
連續功率(RMS)................ 75W/聲道
...................(1 kHz, THD 10%, 6 )
附件
Ω
操作說明書..............................1
設置系統................................1
顯示幕..................................1
遙控器..................................1
電源線..................................1
視頻電纜(黃色插頭)....................1
顯示幕電纜(灰色插頭)..................1
控制電纜A(藍色插頭)..................1
控制電纜B(黑色插頭)..................1
FM天線 .................................1
AM環形天線 .............................1
乾電池(AA/R6).........................2
揚聲器電纜(5 米)......................3
揚聲器電纜(10 米).....................2
防滑墊(中置揚聲器)
(僅限S-DV700ST) ....................3
防滑墊(超低音揚聲器)..................4
揚聲器支架(前置/環繞聲揚聲器)........4
揚聲器支架(中置揚聲器)
(僅限S-DV900ST) ....................1
大螺絲(僅限 S-DV900ST)................8
中螺絲(僅限 S-DV900ST)................2
小螺絲(僅限 S-DV900ST)...............16
蓋板(僅限 S-DV900ST)..................4
碟片部分
數位音頻
特性..............DVD fs: 96 kHz, 24位元
類型......DVD 系統,VCD 系統和 CD 數位音頻
系統
頻率響應
48 kHz取樣................4 Hz-22 kHz
96 kHz取樣................4 Hz-44 kHz
192 kHz取樣...............4 Hz-88 kHz
信噪比.............................108 dB
動態範圍............................95 dB
總諧波失真........................0.005 %
抖晃率...........................測量限制
(±0.001 % W.PEAK)或以下 (JEITA)
FM
調諧器部分
頻率範圍......................87.5-108MHz
天線........................ 75 ,非平衡
Ω
AM
頻率範圍
調諧器部分
....531 kHz至1,602 kHz(使用 9 kHz等級)
...530 kHz至1,700 kHz(使用 10 kHz等級)
天線.............................環形天線
衛星揚聲器系統 (
封閉型防磁式
)
S-DV700ST
揚聲器.....................8.7 cm(錐型)
...........................5.2 cm(錐型)
其他
電源要求
額定阻抗............................. 6
Ω
...AC 110-120 V/220-230 V/240 V,50/60 Hz
功耗................................172 W
待機模式下
頻率範圍.....................80-20,000 Hz
最大輸入....................75 W(JEITA)
前置/環繞聲揚聲器
功耗...............................0.55 W
尺寸
......110(寬) 59(深) 284(高)cm
×
×
尺寸:
DVD/CD調諧器
重量...............................0.7 kg
中置揚聲器
尺寸
......284(寬) 59(深) 110(高)cm
×
......360(寬) 74(高) 270(深)mm
×
顯示幕.274(寬) 44(高) 35(深)mm
×
×
×
×
重量...............................0.7 kg
94
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
S-DV900ST
衛星揚聲器系統 (
)
類型 ........................平板式書架型
揚聲器
• 因產品改進,規格與設計若有變更恕不另
行通知。
振蕩器 ............2.5 cm 振蕩器 × 3
高音揚聲器 ......2.6 cm (半球頂形)
額定阻抗 ............................ 6
Ω
本產品包括NEC公司授權使用的
FontAvenue 字體。FontAvenue是
NEC公司的註冊商標。
頻率範圍 .................100 - 35,000 Hz
最大輸入 ...................75 W(JEITA)
前置/環繞聲揚聲器
尺寸
..... 120(寬) 30(深) 450 (高)cm
×
×
日本先鋒公司出版
重量 .............................. 0.9 kg
版權 2003日本先鋒公司
中置揚聲器
尺寸
..... 420(寬) 32(深) 120 (高)cm
版權所有
×
×
重量 .............................. 0.9 kg
有源超低音揚聲器
(S-DV700SW/S-DV900SW)
類型 ..............低音反射地面型,防磁式
揚聲器 .....................18 cm(錐型)
額定阻抗 ............................ 6
Ω
頻率範圍 .....................25-2,300 Hz
最大輸入 ...................75 W(JEITA)
尺寸
×
.... 192(寬) 436(深) 395 (高)cm
重量 ............................. 12.5 kg
×
95
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
96
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
附加資訊
97
ChH
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PIONEER CORPORATION
4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90810-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R OP2, Canada TEL: (905) 479-4411
PIONEER EUROPE NV
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 656-472-1111
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico,D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270
<TWKCW/03G00001>
Printed in
<ARC7496-A>
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|